dm3730 TRM
dm3730 TRM
dm3730 TRM
Features
Load-Store Architecture With Non-Aligned Support 64 32-Bit General-Purpose Registers Instruction Packing Reduces Code Size All Instructions Conditional Additional C64x+TM Enhancements Protected Mode Operation Expectations Support for Error Detection and Program Redirection Hardware Support for Modulo Loop Operation TM C64x+ L1/L2 Memory Architecture 32K-Byte L1P Program RAM/Cache (Direct Mapped) 80K-Byte L1D Data RAM/Cache (2-Way Set- Associative) 64K-Byte L2 Unified Mapped RAM/Cache (4- Way Set-Associative) 32K-Byte L2 Shared SRAM and 16K-Byte L2 ROM C64x+TM Instruction Set Features Byte-Addressable (8-/16-/32-/64-Bit Data) 8-Bit Overflow Protection Bit-Field Extract, Set, Clear Normalization, Saturation, Bit-Counting Compact 16-Bit Instructions Additional Instructions to Support Complex Multiplies External Memory Interfaces: SDRAM Controller (SDRC) 16, 32-bit Memory Controller With 1G-Byte Total Address Space Interfaces to Low-Power SDRAM SDRAM Memory Scheduler (SMS) and Rotation Engine General Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) 16-bit Wide Multiplexed Address/Data
DM3730/25 Digital Media Processors: Compatible with OMAP 3 Architecture ARM Microprocessor (MPU) Subsystem Up to 1-GHz ARM Cortex-A8 Core Also supports 300, 600, and 800-MHz operation NEON SIMD Coprocessor High Performance Image, Video, Audio (IVA2.2TM) Accelerator Subsystem Up to 800-MHz TMS320C64x+TM DSP Core Also supports 260, 520, and 660-MHz operation Enhanced Direct Memory Access (EDMA) Controller (128 Independent Channels) Video Hardware Accelerators POWERVR SGX Graphics Accelerator (DM3730 only) Tile Based Architecture Delivering up to 20 MPoly/sec Universal Scalable Shader Engine: Multi-threaded Engine Incorporating Pixel and Vertex Shader Functionality Industry Standard API Support: OpenGLES 1.1 and 2.0, OpenVG1.0 Fine Grained Task Switching, Load Balancing, and Power Management Programmable High Quality Image Anti-Aliasing Advanced Very-Long-Instruction-Word (VLIW) TMS320C64x+TM DSP Core Eight Highly Independent Functional Units Six ALUs (32-/40-Bit); Each Supports Single 32- bit, Dual 16-bit, or Quad 8-bit, Arithmetic per Clock Cycle Two Multipliers Support Four 16 x 16-Bit Multiplies (32-Bit Results) per Clock Cycle or Eight 8 x 8-Bit Multiplies (16-Bit Results) per Clock Cycle
1
Please be aware that an important notice concerning availability, standard warranty, and use in critical applications of Texas Instruments semiconductor products and disclaimers thereto appears at the end of this data sheet. POWERVR SGX is a trademark of Imagination Technologies Ltd. OMAP is a trademark of Texas Instruments. Cortex, NEON are trademarks of ARM Limited. ARM is a registered trademark of ARM Ltd. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
PRODUCTION DATA information is current as of publication date. Products conform to specifications per the terms of the Texas Instruments standard warranty. Production processing does not necessarily include testing of all parameters.
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Bus Up to 8 Chip Select Pins With 128M-Byte Address Space per Chip Select Pin Glueless Interface to NOR Flash, NAND Flash (With ECC Hamming Code Calculation), SRAM and Pseudo-SRAM Flexible Asynchronous Protocol Control for Interface to Custom Logic (FPGA, CPLD, ASICs, etc.) Nonmultiplexed Address/Data Mode (Limited 2K-Byte Address Space) 1.8-V I/O and 3.0-V (MMC1 only), 0.9-V to 1.2-V Adaptive Processor Core Voltage 0.9-V to 1.1-V Adaptive Core Logic Voltage Note: These are default Operating Performance Point (OPP) voltages and could be optimized to lower values using SmartReflex AVS. Commercial, Industrial, and Extended Temperature Grades Serial Communication 5 Multichannel Buffered Serial Ports (McBSPs) 512 Byte Transmit/Receive Buffer (McBSP1/3/4/5) 5K-Byte Transmit/Receive Buffer (McBSP2) SIDETONE Core Support (McBSP2 and 3 Only) For Filter, Gain, and Mix Operations Direct Interface to I2S and PCM Device and T Buses 128 Channel Transmit/Receive Mode Four Master/Slave Multichannel Serial Port Interface (McSPI) Ports High-Speed/Full-Speed/Low-Speed USB OTG Subsystem (12-/8-Pin ULPI Interface) High-Speed/Full-Speed/Low-Speed Multiport USB Host Subsystem 12-/8-Pin ULPI Interface or 6-/4-/3-Pin Serial Interface One HDQ/1-Wire Interface Four UARTs (One with Infrared Data Association [IrDA] and Consumer Infrared [CIR] Modes) Three Master/Slave High-Speed Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Controllers Camera Image Signal Processing (ISP) CCD and CMOS Imager Interface Memory Data Input BT.601/BT.656 Digital YCbCr 4:2:2 (8-/10-Bit) Interface
DM3730, DM3725 Digital Media Processors
Glueless Interface to Common Video Decoders Resize Engine Resize Images From 1/4x to 4x Separate Horizontal/Vertical Control System Direct Memory Access (SDMA) Controller (32 Logical Channels With Configurable Priority) Comprehensive Power, Reset, and Clock Management SmartReflexTM Technology Dynamic Voltage and Frequency Scaling (DVFS) ARM Cortex-A8 Core ARMv7 Architecture TrustZone Thumb-2 MMU Enhancements In-Order, Dual-Issue, Superscalar Microprocessor Core NEON Multimedia Architecture Over 2x Performance of ARMv6 SIMD Supports Both Integer and Floating Point SIMD Jazelle RCT Execution Environment Architecture Dynamic Branch Prediction with Branch Target Address Cache, Global History Buffer, and 8-Entry Return Stack Embedded Trace Macrocell (ETM) Support for Non-Invasive Debug ARM Cortex-A8 Memory Architecture: 32K-Byte Instruction Cache (4-Way Set-Associative) 32K-Byte Data Cache (4-Way Set-Associative) 256K-Byte L2 Cache 32K-Byte ROM 64K-Byte Shared SRAM Endianess: ARM Instructions - Little Endian ARM Data Configurable DSP Instructions/Data - Little Endian Removable Media Interfaces: Three Multimedia Card (MMC)/ Secure Digital (SD) With Secure Data I/O (SDIO) Test Interfaces IEEE-1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-Scan Compatible Embedded Trace Macro Interface (ETM) Serial Data Transport Interface (SDTI) 12 32-bit General Purpose Timers 2 32-bit Watchdog Timers
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
1 32-bit Secure Watchdog Timer 1 32-bit 32-kHz Sync Timer Up to 188 General-Purpose I/O (GPIO) Pins (Multiplexed With Other Device Functions) 45-nm CMOS Technology Package-On-Package (POP) Implementation for Memory Stacking (Not Available in CUS Package)
Packages: 515-pin s-PBGA package (CBP Suffix), .5mm Ball Pitch (Top), .4mm Ball Pitch (Bottom) 515-pin s-PBGA package (CBC Suffix), .65mm Ball Pitch (Top), .5mm Ball Pitch (Bottom) 423-pin s-PBGA package (CUS Suffix), .65mm Ball Pitch
DM3730, DM3725 Digital Media Processors Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
1.2
Description
The DM37x generation of high-performance, digital media processors are based on the enhanced device architecture and are integrated on TI's advanced 45-nm process technology. This architecture is designed to provide best in class ARM and Graphics performance while delivering low power consumption. This balance of performance and power allow the device to support the following example applications: Portable Data Terminals Navigation Auto Infotainment Gaming Medical Imaging Home Automation Human Interface Industrial Control Test and Measurement Single board Computers The device can support numerous HLOS and RTOS solutions including Linux and Windows Embedded CE which are available directly from TI. Additionally, the device is fully backward compatible with previous Cortex-A8 processors and OMAP processors. This DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor data manual presents the electrical and mechanical specifications for the DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor. The information contained in this data manual applies to the commercial, industrial, and extended temperature versions of the DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor unless otherwise indicated. It consists of the following sections: A description of the DM3730/25 terminals: assignment, electrical characteristics, multiplexing, and functional description A presentation of the electrical characteristics requirements: power domains, operating conditions, power consumption, and dc characteristics The clock specifications: input and output clocks, DPLL and DLL A description of thermal characteristics, device nomenclature, and mechanical data about the available packaging
DM3730, DM3725 Digital Media Processors Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
1.3
LCD Panel IVA 2.2 Subsystem TMS320DM64x+ DSP Imaging Video and Audio Processor 32K/32K L1$ 48K L1D RAM 64K L2$ 32K L2 RAM 16K L2 ROM Video Hardware MPU Subsystem ARM Cortex- A8 Core TrustZone 32K/32K L1$ POWERVR SGX Graphics Accelerator
TM
Camera (Parallel)
Dual Output 3-Layer Display Processor (1xGraphics, 2xVideo) Temporal Dithering SDTVQCIF Support 32
64 Async 64
32
32
32
32
32
64
32
32
64
64
L3 Interconnect Network-Hierarchial, Performance, and Power Driven 32 32 64 SMS: SDRAM Memory Scheduler/ Rotation 32 32 32 L4 Interconnect GPMC: General Purpose Memory Controller NAND/ NOR Flash, SRAM System Controls PRCM 2xSmartReflexTM Control Module
Peripherals: 4xUART, 3xHigh-Speed I2C, 5xMcBSP (2x with Sidetone/Audio Buffer) 4xMcSPI, 6xGPIO 3xHigh-Speed MMC/SDIO HDQ/1 Wire, 6xMailboxes 12xGPTimers, 2xWDT, 32K Sync Timer
DM3730, DM3725 Digital Media Processors Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Revision History
NOTE: Page numbers for previous revisions may differ from page numbers in the current version.
This data sheet revision history highlights the technical changes made from the previous to the current revision. Revision History
SECTION ADDITIONS/CHANGES/DELETIONS Changed: Table 2-1. Ball Characteristics (CBP Pkg.). Removed restriction note from GPIO_16. Table 2-2. Ball Characteristics (CBC Pkg.). Removed restriction note from GPIO_16. Table 2-3. Ball Characteristics (CUS Pkg.). Removed restriction note from GPIO_16. Changed: Table 3-1. Absolute Maximum Rating over Junction Temperature Range. Added JTAG to VESD. Table 3-5. DC Electrical Characteristics. Removed USIM ball R27. Added note on rise and fall times for these tables: Input Clock Requirements sys_xtalin Squarer Input Clock Timing Requirements - Bypass Mode sys_32k Input Clock Timing Requirements sys_altclk Input Clock Timing Requirements sys_clkout1 Output Clock Switching Characteristics sys_clkout2 Output Clock Switching Characteristics Added: Table 4-2, Crystal Electrical Characteristics. Added entry for DL - Crystal drive level
Terminal Description
Electrical Characteristics
Clock Specifications
DM3730, DM3725 Digital Media Processors Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
2 TERMINAL DESCRIPTION
2.1 Terminal Assignment
Figure 2-1 through Figure 2-5 show the ball locations for the 515- and 423- ball plastic ball grid array (s-PBGA) packages. Table 2-1 through Table 2-25 indicate the signal names and ball grid numbers for both packages. Note: There are no balls present on the top of the 423-ball s-PBGA package.
AH AG AF AE AD AC AB AA Y W V U T R P N M L K J H G F E D C B A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28
030-001
Figure 2-1. DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor CBP s-PBGA-N515 Package (Bottom View)
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
AC AB AA Y W V U T R P N M L K J H G F E D C B A 23 22 21 19 20 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2
030-002
Figure 2-2. DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor CBP s-PBGA-N515 Package (Top View)
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
AF AE AD AC AB AA Y W V U T R P N M L K J H G F E D C B A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
Figure 2-3. DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor CBC s-PBGA-515 Package (Bottom View)
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
AA Y W V U T R P N M L K J H G F E D C B A 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Figure 2-4. DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor CBC s-PBGA-515 Package (Top View)
10
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
AD AC AB AA Y W V U T R P N M L K J H G F E D C B A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Figure 2-5. DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor CUS s-PBGA-N423 Package (Bottom View)
2.2 2.2.1
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
11
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
1 A NC 2 NC 3 vss 4 NC 5 vdds_mem 6 NC 7 NC 8 vdds_mem 9 NC
10
www.ti.com
11 NC 12 vdds_mem 13 NC 14 NC
NC
NC
vss
NC
NC
vdds_mem
NC
NC
vdds_mem
NC
NC
NC
vdds_mem
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
vss
NC
NC
vss
NC
NC
vss
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
vss
vdd_core
vdd_core
vss
NC
NC
vss
NC
NC
NC
vss
vss
NC
H gpmc_nwp
gpmc_d8
gpmc_ncs1
vdd_core
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
J vdds_mem vdds_mem
vss
vdd_core
gpmc_wait3
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
gpmc_d0
gpmc_d9
gpmc_a10
gpmc_a4
gpmc_wait2
vss
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
gpmc_d1
gpmc_d2
gpmc_a9
gpmc_a3
gpmc_wait1
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
pop_k2 _m2
gpmc_a8
gpmc_a2
gpmc_wait0
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
pop_l2 _n2
gpmc_a7
gpmc_a1
gpmc_ncs7
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
P gpmc_d10
gpmc_d3
vss
vss
gpmc_ncs6
vss
vss
A.
12
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com
15 pop_a12 _a15 16 NC 17 NC 18 vdds_mem
19
NC
pop_b12 _b15
NC
NC
vdds_mem
NC
NC
NC
vdds_mem
cam_wen
cam_d2
cam_d10
cam_xclkb
vss
pop_b23 _b28
NC
vdds_mem
NC
NC
vss
NC
NC
vss
cam_fld
cam_d3
cam_xclka
cam_d11
cam_pclk
vdds_mem
vdd_core
vdds_mem
NC
NC
vss
NC
vss
vdd_core
vdd_core
cam_d4
dss_pclk
vdd_core
vdds
vdds
dss_data8
dss_data7
dss_data16 dss_data9
vss
vdds_mem
NC
NC
NC
uart3_cts _rctx
uart3_rts _sd
uart3_rx _irrx
uart3_tx _irtx
vdds
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vss
vdd_core
vdd_core
vdd_core
i2c1_sda
hdq_sio
dss_data21
pop_h22 _j27
pop_k1 _j28
vdda_dplls _dll
vss
vss
vdd_core
vss
vdd_core
i2c1_scl
vdds_ mmc1
mcbsp1_fsx
cam_d8
cam_d6
vss
vss
cap_vdd _sram_core
vdd_core
vss
cam_d9
cam_d7
vdd_core
vss
mcbsp2_dx
vdd_core
pop_k22 _m26
mmc1 _cmd
vss
vdd_core
vdd_core
mcbsp2 _clkx
mmc1 _dat2
mmc1 _dat1
mmc1 _dat0
vss
vdd_core mcbsp2_fsx
vdds_x
gpio_127
gpio_126
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
13
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
gpmc_d11
gpmc_d12
gpmc_a6
vdds_mem
gpmc_ncs5
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
gpmc_d4
gpmc_d13
gpmc_a5
gpmc_clk
gpmc_ncs4
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vdds_mem
vss
gpmc_ncs3
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
gpmc_d5
gpmc_d6
gpmc_ncs2
vss
vss
W gpmc_d14
gpmc_d7
vss
vdds
uart1_cts
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vss
Y gpmc_d15
mcspi2_ simo
mcspi2 _somi
mcspi2 _cs0
uart1_rx
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
AA
pop_aa1 _aa1
mcspi2_clk
mcspi1 _somi
uart1_tx
uart1_rts
jtag_emu1 jtag_emu0
jtag_rtck
jtag_tck
vdda_wkup _bg_bb
AB
mcspi1 _cs2
mcspi1_clk
mcspi1 _simo
AC
mcbsp4 _fsx
mcspi1 _cs0
mcspi1_cs1 vdd_core
AD mcbsp4_dr mcbsp4_dx
vdds
vdds
AE
mcbsp4 _clkx
mmc2 _clk
mcbsp3_fsx mcbsp3_dr
etk_d10
vdds
vdd_core
etk_ctl
etk_d4
vss
etk_d3
sys_boot2
AF
pop_ac8 _af1
pop_u2 _af2
mcbsp3 _clkx
mcbsp3_dx
etk_d11
vdds
etk_d8
etk_clk
etk_d0
vss
etk_d6
i2c3_scl
AG
pop_ab1 _ag1
vss
vss
mmc2 _dat2
mmc2 _cmd
vss
etk_d12
etk_d14
etk_d9
etk_d1
i2c3_sda
AH
pop_ac1 _ah1 1
pop_ac2 _ah2 2
mmc2 _dat5 3
mmc2 _dat1 4
mmc2 _dat0 5
vdds_mem 6
etk_d13 7
etk_d15 8
etk_d5 9
etk_d2 12
etk_d7 14
14
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
vss
vss
mcbsp2_dr
gpio_129
vss
gpio_128
hsusb0_dir
vdd_core
vss
mcbsp_clks
hsusb0_stp hsusb0_nxt
hsusb0_clk
vdd_core
vdd_core
mcbsp1_dr
hsusb0 _data4
hsusb0 _data3
hsusb0 _data1
vss
vdd_core
mcbsp1_dx
vdda_dac
vdd_mpu _iva
vdds_sram
vss
vdd_core
vss
vdd_core
mcbsp1 _clkx
vss
vdd_core
sys_ xtalgnd
vdd_core
vdd_core
vdd_core
mcbsp1 _clkr
vss
vssa_dac
cvideo1 _vfb
cvideo1 _out
vdda_dpll _per
jtag_ntrst
jtag_tms _tmsc
jtag_tdo
jtag_tdi
mcbsp1_fsr
uart2_tx
NC
dss_ data15
dss_ data14
AA
uart2_rts
uart2_cts
dss_data13 dss_data12
AB
vss
vss
dss_ data22
dss_ data23
AC
uart2_rx
i2c4_scl
dss_data11 dss_data10
AD
i2c2_sda
vdds
sys_xtalin
vdd_core
vdd_core
vss
sys_boot5 sys_clkout2
vdds
vdd_core
sys_32k
i2c4_sda
NC
pop_aa23 _ae28
AE
i2c2_scl
vdds
vss
sys_boot6
sys_off _mode
vdds
sys_nirq
pop_aa22 _af27
pop_h23 _af28
AF
vss
cam_d0
gpio_114
gpio_112
vdds
vdds
dss_data0 dss_data2
vdds
pop_ab23 _ag28
AG
pop_ac14 _ah16 16
cam_d1 17
gpio_115 18
gpio_113
19
cap_vddu _array 20
vss 21
dss_data1 22
dss_data3 23
dss_data5 24
pop_ac22 _ah27 27
pop_ac23 _ah28 28
AH
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
15
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
1 A pop_a1 _a1 2 NC 3 gpmc_ ncs2 4 gpmc _a11 5 NC 6 vss 7 NC 8 vss 9 NC
10
www.ti.com
11 NC 12 NC 13 vss
NC
NC
vss
gpmc_ wait2
gpmc_ ncs4
gpmc_ ncs6
gpmc_ ncs3
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
C I2C2_SDA
i2c2_scl
sys_ boot2
gpmc_ ncs5
gpmc_ ncs7
NC
NC
NC
NC
vdds
vss
NC
gpmc _a9
gpmc _a10
sys_ boot1
sys_ boot6
NC
vss
NC
vdds
vss
NC
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
gpmc _a7
gpmc _a8
sys_ boot3
sys_ boot4
gpmc _a5
gpmc _a6
sys_ boot0
NC
vss
gpmc _a4
sys_ boot5
vdds
NC
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vdd_ core
vdd_mpu _iva
NC
gpmc _a2
gpmc _a3
uart1 _rx
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
gpmc _nbe1
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
vss
mmc2 _dat7
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
vdd_mpu _iva
NC
pop_j1 _l1
mmc2 _dat6
uart1 _tx
vdds
NC
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
gpmc _nwe
gpmc _d15
mmc2 _dat5
vdds
vdd_ core
NC
vdd_mpu _iva
gpmc _clk
gpmc _noe
mcbsp3 _dr
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
A.
16
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com
14 NC 15 NC 16 NC
17
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
cam_fld
cam_d3
vss
pop_ b21_b26
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
cam_hs
cam_d5
cam_ xclka
cam_ pclk
vss
vdd_ core
NC
NC
vss
NC
vss
NC
NC
cam_vs
cam_d4
cam_d10
cam_ strobe
vss
NC
vdds
cam_ xclkb
cam_d11
dss_ data20
dss_ acbias
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
vss
vss
dss_ pclk
dss_ data6
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
vdd_ core
NC
dss_ data7
dss_ data8
NC
vdds
NC
NC
vdds
NC
NC
hdq_sio
i2c1_sda
i2c1_scl
dss_ data9
vss
NC
NC
mmc1_ dat2
NC
NC
dss_ hsync
vss
pop_ h21_k26
vss
mmc1_ cmd
vss
vdds
vss
vdds
dss_ data16
dss_ data17
vdd_ core
mmc1_ dat1
mmc1_ dat0
gpio_126
NC
dss_ data18
dss_ vsync
dss_ data19
vss
NC
mmc1_ clk
mmc1_ dat3
vdds_ mmc1
dss_ data21
cam_d8
cam_d9
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
17
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
gpmc _d13
NC
mcbsp3 _dx
NC
mcspi1 _somi
mcspi1 _simo
mcspi1 _clk
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
uart1 _rts
mcbsp4 _dx
vss
mcspi1 _cs0
mcspi1 _cs1
mcspi1 _cs2
mmc2 _cmd
gpmc _d10
pop_n2 _t2
mcbsp4 _fsx
vdds
vdd_ core
mcspi1 _cs3
mmc2 _dat1
mmc2 _dat0
gpmc _d12
gpmc _d11
mcbsp3 _clkx
mcbsp4 _dr
vdd_mpu _iva
mcspi2 _somi
mmc2 _dat3
mmc2 _dat2
vdd_mpu _iva
vdds_ sram
gpmc _d8
etk_d9
mcbsp4 _clkx
NC
vdd_mpu _iva
mcspi2 _cs0
mcspi2 _cs1
mmc2 _dat4
vdd_mpu _iva
sys_off _mode
vss
uart1 _cts
mcbsp3 _fsx
vss
mcspi2 _clk
mcspi2 _simo
vdd_mpu _iva
mmc2 _clk
sys_ clkout2
NC
gpmc _d9
pop_t2 _y2
etk_d4
vdds
vss
vdd_ core
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_ core
jtag_ tdo
AA
gpmc _d1
gpmc _d0
etk_d3
etk_d8
AB
etk_d5
etk_clk
etk_ctl
i2c3_scl
vss
AC
gpmc _d3
gpmc _d2
etk_d0
i2c3_sda
gpmc _d7
gpmc _nwp
vdds
gpmc _wait1
NC
vss
gpmc _wait0
NC
NC
AD
gpmc _ncs1
etk_d7
etk_d2
etk_d1
gpmc _d6
gpmc _d5
gpmc _ncs0
NC
gpmc_ nadv_ale
NC
NC
NC
AE
NC
pop_w2 _ae2
etk_d6
etk_d10
gpmc _d4
etk_d12
vss
NC
etk_d15
vdds
NC
NC
NC
AF
NC 1
NC 2
NC 3
pop_y2 _af4 4
pop_aa6 _af5 5
etk_d11
etk_d13 7
pop_y7_ _af8 8
etk_d14 9
pop_y9_ _af10
10
NC 11
pop_aa10 _af12 12
pop_aa11 _af13 13
18
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
gpio_127
gpio_128
gpio_129
mcbsp1 _fsx
vdds_x
NC
cam_d6
cam_d7
vss
mcbsp2 _clkx
mcbsp2 _dx
vdd_ core
NC
NC
NC
NC
mcbsp1 _clkx
mcbsp2 _dr
mcbsp _clks
mcbsp1 _dr
vss
vdds
NC
NC
vdda_ dpll_per
jtag_tdi
mcbsp1 _dx
mcbsp2 _fsx
mcbsp1 _clkr
hsusb0 _stp
NC
cvideo2 _vfb
vss
pop_ p21_u26
jtag_tck
sys_nirq
mcbsp1 _fsr
hsusb0 _data2
hsusb0 _dir
hsusb0 _data0
cvideo1 _rset
vssa_ dac
vdda_ dac
cvideo2 _out
sys_ clkreq
i2c4_sda
hsusb0 _data4
hsusb0 _nxt
hsusb0 _clk
hsusb0 _data3
vss
vdds
cvideo1 _vfb
cvideo1 _out
jtag_ emu0
vss
hsusb0 _data7
hsusb0 _data5
hsusb0 _data6
hsusb0 _data1
NC
uart2 _cts
dss_ data13
vss
NC
uart2 _rts
dss_ data12
dss_ data14
AA
vss
NC
vdds
dss_ data23
dss_ data15
AB
NC
vdds
vss
NC
vdds
vss
NC
vdd_ core
NC
NC
vdds
dss_ data22
dss_ data10
AC
vss
i2c4_scl
gpio_113
gpio_112
vdds
vdds
vdds
uart2 _rx
uart2 _tx
dss_ data4
dss_ data5
vss
dss_ data11
AD
sys_ clkout1
cam_d1
cam_d0
gpio_115
gpio_114
sys_32k
dss_ data0
dss_ data1
dss_ data2
dss_ data3
pop_y20 _ae25
pop_y21 _ae26
AE
pop_aa12 _af14 14
pop_aa13 _af15 15
pop_aa14 _af16 16
pop_y14 _af17
17
pop_aa17 _af18 18
sys_ xtalout 20
pop_y17 _af21 21
pop_ aa19_af22 22
sys _xtalgnd 23
pop_y19 _af24 24
pop_aa20 _af25 25
pop_aa21 _af26 26
AF
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
19
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
1 A NC 2 NC 3 4 sdrc_a0 5 sdrc _dqs0 6 7 sdrc _dm2 8 sdrc _dqs2 9
10
www.ti.com
11 sdrc _nclk 12
sdrc _clk
NC
sdrc_a4
sdrc_a3
sdrc_a1
sdrc_d3
sdrc _dm0
sdrc_d7
sdrc_d18
sdrc_d19
sdrc_d21
sdrc_d8
sdrc_d10
gpmc _wait0
gpmc _wait3
sdrc_a5
sdrc_d1
sdrc_d2
sdrc_d6
sdrc_d16
sdrc_d20
sdrc_d9
gpmc _ncs3
sdrc_a2
sdrc_d0
sdrc_d4
sdrc_d5
sdrc_d22
gpmc _ncs0
sdrc_a6
sdrc_a10
sdrc_a9
sdrc_a8
sdrc_d17
gpmc _noe
gpmc _ncs6
gpmc _ncs4
sdrc_a7
sdrc_a13
sdrc_a14
vdd_ core
gpmc _a10
gpmc _nwe
gpmc _ncs7
gpmc _ncs5
sdrc_a11
sdrc_a12
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_ core
gpmc _a8
gpmc _a9
vdds_x
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vdd_ core
gpmc _a7
gpmc _a6
gpmc _a5
gpmc _a4
vdds _mem
vdds _mem
vdds _mem
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vss
gpmc _a3
gpmc _a2
gpmc _a1
gpmc_ nbe0_cle
vdds _mem
vdds _mem
vdds _mem
vss
vss
gpmc_ nbe1
gpmc _d0
vss
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
gpmc _d1
gpmc _d2
gpmc _d4
mcspi2 _cs1
mcspi2 _cs0
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vss
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
A.
20
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com
13 sdrc_ dqs1 14 sdrc_ d14
15
sdrc_ dm1
sdrc_ d13
sdrc_ d15
sdrc_ d27
sdrc_ d30
sdrc_ d31
sdrc_ ncs1
sdrc_ cke0
cam_d5
cam_ xclka
sdrc_ d12
sdrc_ d26
sdrc_ d28
sdrc_ ba0
sdrc_ ncas
sdrc_ cke1
cam_ xclkb
sdrc_ d11
sdrc_ d25
sdrc_ d29
sdrc_ ba1
sdrc_ nras
sdrc_ d23
sdrc_ d24
vdds_ mem
cam_vs
dss_ hsync
dss_ data7
dss_ data8
vdd_ core
vdds_ mem
vdds_ mem
cam_wen
cam_d3
cam_d10
dss_ vsync
dss_ data9
vdd_ core
vdds_ mem
cam_d2
cam_d4
cam_d11
dss_ pclk
dss_ data17
dss_ data18
vdd_ core
vss
vdds_ mem
vss
dss_ data19
cam_fld
vss
vss
vss
vss
vdd_ core
cam_ pclk
cam_ strobe
dss_ acbias
dss_ data16
cam_d8
vss
vss
vdd_ core
vdd_ core
vdd_ core
i2c1_scl
i2c1_sda
dss_ data21
cam_d9
cam_d7
vss
vdd_ core
vdd_ core
vss
mmc1_ cmd
cam_d6
vss
vdd_ core
vdd_ core
vss
vdds
vdds
vdds
mmc1_ dat2
mmc1_ dat1
mmc1_ dat0
mmc1_ clk
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
21
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
gpmc _d3
mcspi2 _somi
mcspi2 _simo
mcspi2 _clk
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vss
vss
vss
gpmc _d5
gpmc _d6
vss
vss
vss
vss
gpmc _d7
gpmc _d8
gpmc _d11
mcspi1 _simo
mcbsp1 _cs3
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vss
gpmc _d9
gpmc _d12
mcspi1 _somi
mcspi1 _clk
mcspi1 _cs0
vdd_mpu _iva
vss
vss
vss
vss
gpmc _d10
gpmc _d13
vss
vdds
vss
vdd_mpu _iva
gpmc _d14
gpmc _d15
mmc2 _dat3
mcbsp3 _fsx
mcbsp3 _dr
mcbsp3 _dx
uart1 _rx
vdds
vdds
vdd_mpu _iva
gpmc _clk
mmc2 _dat2
mcbsp3 _clkx
uart1 _rts
uart1 _tx
vdds
vdds
vdd_mpu _iva
mmc2 _clk
mmc2 _dat6
mmc2 _dat1
sys_ clkout1
vdds
cap_vddu_ wkup_logic
AA
mmc2 _dat7
mmc2 _dat5
sys_ clkout2
jtag_ rtck
jtag_tms _tmsc
vdds_ sram
AB
mmc2 _dat4
mmc2 _dat0
mmc2 _cmd
jtag_ tck
jtag_ ntrst
jtag_ tdo
sys_ boot0
AC
etk_clk
uart1_ cts
etk_d10
etk_d8
etk_d4
etk_d1
etk_d2
etk_d6
etk_d11
etk_d12
etk_d14
i2c3_sda
AD
NC 1
etk_d5
etk_ctl
etk_d9
etk_d0
etk_d3
etk_d7
etk_d13
etk_d15
10
11
12
22
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
vss
vss
vss
vss
vdds
vdds
vdds
cap_vddu _array
gpio_126
mmc1_ dat3
vdds_ mmc1
vss
vss
vss
vss
hsusb0 _dir
gpio_129
vss
vss
vdd_ core
vdd_ core
vdd_ core
mcbsp2 _dx
hsusb0 _clk
hsusb0 _nxt
hsusb0 _stp
vss
vss
vss
vss
vdd_ core
vdd_ core
vdd_ core
mcbsp2 _clkx
hsusb0 _data7
hsusb0 _data1
hsusb0 _data0
vss
vss
vss
hsusb0 _data3
hsusb0 _data2
vss
vss
mcbsp1 _clkx
mcbsp2 _dr
mcbsp2 _fsx
dss_ data22
dss_ data15
hsusb0 _data5
vdd_mpu _iva
sys_ xtalgnd
sys_ nirq
mcbsp1 _dx
mcbsp1 _clkr
dss_ data23
dss_ data14
hsusb0 _data6
hsusb0 _data4
i2c4_sda
i2c4_scl
mcbsp1 _dr
dss_ data13
cvideo2 _vfb
cvideo1 _rset
sys_ boot6
sys_32k
mcbsp _clks
mcbsp1 _fsx
cvideo2 _out
AA
vssa_dac
sys_ boot5
cam_d0
dss_ data1
mcbsp1 _fsr
dss_ data12
cvideo1 _vfb
cvideo1 _out
AB
i2c3_scl
i2c2_sda
i2c2_scl
sys_ boot1
sys_ boot4
cam_d1
dss_ data0
dss_ data3
dss_ data5
dss_ data10
dss_ data11
jtag_ emu0
AC
sys_ xtaout 13 14
sys_ xtalin
15
sys_ boot2 16 17
sys_ boot3 18 19
dss_ data2 20
dss_ data4 21 22
sys_off _mode 23
jtag_ emu1 24
AD
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
23
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
2.3
Ball Characteristics
Table 2-1 through Table 2-3 describe the terminal characteristics and the signals multiplexed on each pin for the CBP, CBC, and CUS packages, respectively. The following list describes the table column headers. 1. BALL BOTTOM: Ball number(s) on the bottom side associated with each signal(s) on the bottom. 2. PIN NAME: Names of signals multiplexed on each ball (also notice that the name of the pin is the signal name in mode 0). Note: Table 2-3 does not take into account subsystem pin multiplexing options. Subsystem pin multiplexing options are described in Section 2.5, Signal Descriptions. 3. MODE: Multiplexing mode number. (a) Mode 0 is the primary mode; this means that when mode 0 is set, the function mapped on the pin corresponds to the name of the pin. There is always a function mapped on the primary mode. Notice that primary mode is not necessarily the default mode. Note: The default mode is the mode at the release of the reset; also see the RESET REL. MODE column. (b) Modes 1 to 7 are possible modes for alternate functions. On each pin, some modes are effectively used for alternate functions, while some modes are not used and do not correspond to a functional configuration. 4. TYPE: Signal direction I = Input O = Output I/O = Input/Output D = Open drain DS = Differential A = Analog PWR = Power GND = Ground Note: In the safe_mode, the buffer is configured in high-impedance. 5. BALL RESET STATE: The state of the terminal at the power-on reset. 0: The buffer drives VOL (pulldown/pullup resistor not activated) 0(PD): The buffer drives VOL with an active pulldown resistor. 1: The buffer drives VOH (pulldown/pullup resistor not activated) 1(PU): The buffer drives VOH with an active pullup resistor. Z: High-impedance L: High-impedance with an active pulldown resistor H : High-impedance with an active pullup resistor 6. BALL RESET REL. STATE: The state of the terminal at the release of the System Control Module reset (PRCM CORE_RSTPWRON_RET reset signal). 0: The buffer drives VOL (pulldown/pullup resistor not activated) 0(PD): The buffer drives VOL with an active pulldown resistor. 1: The buffer drives VOH (pulldown/pullup resistor not activated) 1(PU): The buffer drives VOH with an active pullup resistor. Z: High-impedance L: High-impedance with an active pulldown resistor H : High-impedance with an active pullup resistor 7. RESET REL. MODE: The mode is automatically configured at the release of the System Control Module reset (PRCM CORE_RSTPWRON_RET reset signal). 8. POWER: The voltage supply that powers the terminals I/O buffers. 9. HYS: Indicates if the input buffer is with hysteresis. 10. BUFFER STRENGTH: Drive strength of the associated output buffer.
24
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
11. PULL U/D - TYPE: Denotes the presence of an internal pullup or pulldown resistor. Pullup and pulldown resistors can be enabled or disabled via software. Note: The pullup/pulldown drive strength is equal to minimum = 50A, typical = 100 A, maximum = 250 A (unless otherwise specified), except for CBP balls P27, P26, R27, and R25, and CUS balls N22 and P24, where the pulldown drive strength is equal to 1.8 k. 12. IO CELL: IO cell information. Note: Configuring two pins to the same input signal is not supported as it can yield unexpected results. This can be easily prevented with the proper software configuration. NOTE
In the DM3730/25 device, new Far End load Settings registers are added for some IOs. This new feature configures the IO according to the transmission line and the application/peripheral load. For a full description on these registers, see the System Control Module / SCM Functional Description / Functional Register Description / Signal Integrity Parameter Control Registers with Pad Group Assignment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
MODE [3]
TYPE [4]
IO CELL [12] LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS
sdrc_d0 sdrc_d1 sdrc_d2 sdrc_d3 sdrc_d4 sdrc_d5 sdrc_d6 sdrc_d7 sdrc_d8 sdrc_d9 sdrc_d10 sdrc_d11 sdrc_d12 sdrc_d13 sdrc_d14 sdrc_d15 sdrc_d16 sdrc_d17 sdrc_d18 sdrc_d19 sdrc_d20 sdrc_d21 sdrc_d22 sdrc_d23 sdrc_d24 sdrc_d25 sdrc_d26 sdrc_d27 sdrc_d28 sdrc_d29 sdrc_d30 sdrc_d31 sdrc_ba0 sdrc_ba1
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O O
PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD NA NA
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
25
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
IO CELL [12] LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS
sdrc_a0 sdrc_a1 sdrc_a2 sdrc_a3 sdrc_a4 sdrc_a5 sdrc_a6 sdrc_a7 sdrc_a8 sdrc_a9 sdrc_a10 sdrc_a11 sdrc_a12 sdrc_a13 sdrc_a14 sdrc_ncs0 sdrc_ncs1 sdrc_clk sdrc_nclk sdrc_cke0 safe_mode_out1(13)
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 0 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7
O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O IO O O
NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA PU/ PD NA PU/ PD
NA
J23
sdrc_cke1 safe_mode_out1(13)
vdds_mem
NA
(12)
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA N4
sdrc_nras sdrc_ncas sdrc_nwe sdrc_dm0 sdrc_dm1 sdrc_dm2 sdrc_dm3 sdrc_dqs0 sdrc_dqs1 sdrc_dqs2 sdrc_dqs3 gpmc_a1 gpio_34 safe_mode
O O O O O O O IO IO IO IO O IO
1 1 1 0 0 0 0 L L L L L
1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Z Z Z Z L
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7
vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem
4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 8
(12) (12) (12) (12) (12) (12) (12) (12) (12) (12) (12)
LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS
M4
AB15
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
L4
AC16
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
K4
AB16
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
T3
AC17
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R3
AB17
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
26
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 4 7
O IO
M3
AB18
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
L3
AC19
O I IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
K3
AB19
O I IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
NA
AC20
gpmc_a11 safe_mode
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
K1 L1 L2 P2 T1 V1 V2 W2 H2
M2 M1 N2 N1 R2 R1 T2 T1 AB3
gpmc_d0 gpmc_d1 gpmc_d2 gpmc_d3 gpmc_d4 gpmc_d5 gpmc_d6 gpmc_d7 gpmc_d8 gpio_44 safe_mode
IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO
H H H H H H H H H
H H H H H H H H H
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8
K2
AC3
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
P1
AB4
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R1
AC4
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R2
AB6
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
T2
AC6
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
W1
AB7
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
Y1
AC7
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
G4 H3
Y2 Y1
O O IO
1 H
1 1
0 0
vdds_mem vdds_mem
NA Yes
8 8
NA PU/ PD
LVCMOS LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
27
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 4 7 0 2 4 7
O IO
U8
NA
O I IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
T8
NA
O I IO IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R8
NA
O I I IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
P8
NA
O I IO IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
N8
NA
O O IO IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
T4
W2
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
F3 G2 F4 G3
W1 V2 V1 AC12
O O O O IO
0 1 1 L
0 1 1 0
0 0 0 0
NA NA NA Yes
8 8 8 8
U3
NA
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
H1
AB10
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
M8 L8
AB12 AC10
I I IO
H H
H H
0 7
vdds_mem vdds_mem
Yes Yes
NA 8
PU/ PD PU/ PD
LVCMOS LVCMOS
K8
NA
I O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
28
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
0 1 2 4 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7
I I I IO
D28
NA
O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
D26
NA
O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
D27
NA
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
E27
NA
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AG22
NA
IO I IO
vdds
Yes
8 NA 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AH22
NA
IO O IO
vdds
Yes
8 8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AG23
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AH23
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AG24
NA
IO I IO
vdds
Yes
8 NA 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AH24
NA
IO O IO
vdds
Yes
8 8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
E26
NA
IO O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
F28
NA
IO I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
29
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7
IO I IO O
G26
NA
IO O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AD28
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AD27
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AB28
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AB27
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AA28
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AA27
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
G25
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
H27
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
H26
NA
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
H25
NA
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
E28
NA
O IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
J26
NA
O IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
30
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
0 2 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4
O O IO IO
AC28
NA
O IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
NA NA NA NA NA NA
AO AO AO AO AIO IO IO O
0 0 0 0 0 L
0 0 NA NA NA L
0 0 0 0 0 7
NA NA NA NA No Yes
NA NA NA NA NA PU/ PD
10-bit DAC 10-bit DAC 10-bit DAC 10-bit DAC 10-bit DAC LVCMOS
A23
NA
IO IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C25
NA
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C27
NA
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C23
NA
IO IO IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AG17
NA
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/PD
LVCMOS
AH17
NA
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/PD
LVCMOS
B24
NA
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C24
NA
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
D24
NA
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
A25
NA
cam_d5 gpio_104
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
31
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
hw_dbg7 safe_mode K28 NA cam_d6 gpio_105 safe_mode L28 NA cam_d7 gpio_106 safe_mode K27 NA cam_d8 gpio_107 safe_mode L27 NA cam_d9 gpio_108 safe_mode B25 NA cam_d10 gpio_109 hw_dbg8 safe_mode C26 NA cam_d11 gpio_110 hw_dbg9 safe_mode B26 NA cam_xclkb gpio_111 safe_mode B23 NA cam_wen cam_shutter gpio_167 hw_dbg10 safe_mode D25 NA cam_strobe gpio_126 hw_dbg11 safe_mode AG19 NA gpio_112 safe_mode AH19 NA gpio_113 safe_mode AG18 NA gpio_114 safe_mode AH18 NA gpio_115 safe_mode P21 NA mcbsp2_fsx gpio_116 safe_mode N21 NA mcbsp2_clkx gpio_117 safe_mode R21 NA mcbsp2_dr gpio_118 safe_mode M21 NA mcbsp2_dx gpio_119 safe_mode
5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 4 7 4 7 4 7 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/PD
LVCMOS
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/PD
LVCMOS
I I IO IO
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/PD
LVCMOS
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/PD
LVCMOS
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
32
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
BUFFER PULLUP STRENGTH /DOWN (mA) [10] TYPE [11] 1 PU/ PD(5)
0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 4 7 4 7 4 7 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0
O IO
M27
NA
IO IO
vdds_mmc1( Yes
15)
PU/ PD(5)
LVCMOS
N27
NA
IO IO
vdds_mmc1( Yes
15)
PU/ PD (5)
LVCMOS
N26
NA
IO IO
vdds_mmc1( Yes
15)
PU/ PD(5)
LVCMOS
N25
NA
IO IO
vdds_mmc1( Yes
15)
PU/ PD (5)
LVCMOS
P28
NA
IO IO
vdds_mmc1( Yes
15)
PU/ PD (5)
LVCMOS
P27
NA
gpio_126(1) safe_mode
IO
vdds_x
Yes
PU/ PD (5)
LVCMOS
P26
NA
gpio_127(1) safe_mode
IO
vdds_x
Yes
PU/ PD(5)
LVCMOS
R27
NA
gpio_128 safe_mode
IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R25
NA
gpio_129(1) safe_mode
IO
vdds_x
Yes
PU/ PD(5)
LVCMOS
AE2
NA
O IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AG5
NA
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AH5
NA
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AH4
NA
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AG4
NA
IO O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AF4
NA
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AE4
NA
mmc2_dat4
IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
33
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
mmc2_dir_dat0 mmc3_dat0 gpio_136 safe_mode AH3 NA mmc2_dat5 mmc2_dir_dat1 cam_global_reset mmc3_dat1 gpio_137 mm3_rxdp safe_mode AF3 NA mmc2_dat6 mmc2_dir_cmd cam_shutter mmc3_dat2 gpio_138 safe_mode AE3 NA mmc2_dat7 mmc2_clkin mmc3_dat3 gpio_139 mm3_rxdm safe_mode AF6 NA mcbsp3_dx uart2_cts gpio_140 safe_mode AE6 NA mcbsp3_dr uart2_rts gpio_141 safe_mode AF5 NA mcbsp3_clkx uart2_tx gpio_142 safe_mode AE5 NA mcbsp3_fsx uart2_rx gpio_143 safe_mode AB26 NA uart2_cts mcbsp3_dx gpt_9_pwm_evt gpio_144 safe_mode AB25 NA uart2_rts mcbsp3_dr gpt_10_pwm_evt gpio_145 safe_mode AA25 NA uart2_tx mcbsp3_clkx gpt_11_pwm_evt gpio_146 safe_mode
1 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 6 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7
O IO IO
IO O IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O O IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O I IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
34
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
0 1 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 4 6 7 0 4 6 7 0 4 6 7 0 4 6 7 0 1 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0
I IO IO IO
AA8
NA
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AA9
NA
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
W8
NA
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
Y8
NA
I IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AE1
NA
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AD1
NA
I IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AD2
NA
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AC1
NA
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
Y21
NA
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AA21
NA
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
V21
NA
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
U21
NA
I IO I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
T21
NA
mcbsp_clks
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
35
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
cam_shutter gpio_160 uart1_cts safe_mode K26 NA mcbsp1_fsx mcspi4_cs0 mcbsp3_fsx gpio_161 safe_mode W21 NA mcbsp1_clkx mcbsp3_clkx gpio_162 safe_mode H18 NA uart3_cts_rctx gpio_163 safe_mode H19 NA uart3_rts_sd gpio_164 safe_mode H20 NA uart3_rx_irrx gpio_165 safe_mode H21 NA uart3_tx_irtx gpio_166 safe_mode T28 NA hsusb0_clk gpio_120 safe_mode T25 NA hsusb0_stp gpio_121 safe_mode R28 NA hsusb0_dir gpio_122 safe_mode T26 NA hsusb0_nxt gpio_124 safe_mode T27 NA hsusb0_data0 uart3_tx_irtx gpio_125 uart2_tx safe_mode U28 NA hsusb0_data1 uart3_rx_irrx gpio_130 uart2_rx safe_mode U27 NA hsusb0_data2 uart3_rts_sd gpio_131 uart2_rts safe_mode U26 NA hsusb0_data3 uart3_cts_rctx
2 4 5 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2
O IO I
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO I
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
36
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
gpio_169 uart2_cts safe_mode U25 NA hsusb0_data4 gpio_188 safe_mode V28 NA hsusb0_data5 gpio_189 safe_mode V27 NA hsusb0_data6 gpio_190 safe_mode V26 NA hsusb0_data7 gpio_191 safe_mode K21 J21 AF15 NA NA NA i2c1_scl i2c1_sda i2c2_scl gpio_168 safe_mode AE15 NA i2c2_sda gpio_183 safe_mode AF14 NA i2c3_scl gpio_184 safe_mode AG14 NA i2c3_sda gpio_185 safe_mode AD26 NA i2c4_scl sys_ nvmode1 safe_mode AE26 NA i2c4_sda sys_ nvmode2 safe_mode J25 NA hdq_sio sys_altclk i2c2_sccbe i2c3_sccbe gpio_170 safe_mode AB3 NA mcspi1_clk mmc2_dat4 gpio_171 safe_mode AB4 NA mcspi1_ simo mmc2_dat5 gpio_172 safe_mode AA4 NA mcspi1_ somi mmc2_dat6 gpio_173 safe_mode AC2 NA mcspi1_cs0
4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 7 0 1 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0
IO I
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
OD IOD OD IO
H H H
H H H
0 0 7
NA Yes Yes
3 3 3 4
IOD IO
vdds
Yes
3 4
OD IO
vdds
Yes
3 4
IOD IO
vdds
Yes
3 4
OD O
vdds
Yes
3 4
PU/ PD(6)(7)
Open Drain
IOD O
vdds
Yes
3 4
PU/ PD(6)(7)
Open Drain
IOD I OD OD IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
37
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
mmc2_dat7 gpio_174 safe_mode AC3 NA mcspi1_cs1 mmc3_cmd gpio_175 safe_mode AB1 NA mcspi1_cs2 mmc3_clk gpio_176 safe_mode AB2 NA mcspi1_cs3 hsusb2_ data2 gpio_177 mm2_txdat safe_mode AA3 NA mcspi2_clk hsusb2_ data7 gpio_178 safe_mode Y2 NA mcspi2_ simo gpt_9_pwm_evt hsusb2_ data4 gpio_179 safe_mode Y3 NA mcspi2_ somi gpt_10_pwm_evt hsusb2_ data5 gpio_180 safe_mode Y4 NA mcspi2_cs0 gpt_11_pwm_evt hsusb2_ data6 gpio_181 safe_mode V3 NA mcspi2_cs1 gpt_8_pwm_evt hsusb2_ data3 gpio_182 mm2_txen_n safe_mode AE25 AE17 AF17 AF25 NA NA NA NA sys_32k sys_xtalin sys_xtalout sys_clkreq gpio_1 safe_mode AF26 NA sys_nirq gpio_0 safe_mode AH25 AF24 NA NA sys_nrespwron sys_nreswarm gpio_30
1 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 5 7 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 4
IO IO
O IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I AI AO IO IO
Z Z Z 0
Z Z 0 See (11)
0 0 0 0
NA NA NA 4
PU/ PD No NA PU/ PD
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IOD IO
Z 0
Z H
0 0
vdds vdds
Yes Yes
NA 4
No PU/ PD
38
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
safe_mode AH26 NA sys_boot0 dss_data18 gpio_2 safe_mode AG26 NA sys_boot1 dss_data19 gpio_3 safe_mode AE14 NA sys_boot2 gpio_4 safe_mode AF18 NA sys_boot3 dss_data20 gpio_5 safe_mode AF19 NA sys_boot4 mmc2_dir_dat2 dss_data21 gpio_6 safe_mode AE21 NA sys_boot5 mmc2_dir_dat3 dss_data22 gpio_7 safe_mode AF21 NA sys_boot6 dss_data23 gpio_8 safe_mode AF22 NA sys_off_mode gpio_9 safe_mode AG25 NA sys_clkout1 gpio_10 safe_mode AE22 NA sys_clkout2 gpio_186 safe_mode AA17 AA13 AA12 AA18 AA20 AA19 AA11 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA jtag_ntrst jtag_tck jtag_rtck jtag_tms_tmsc jtag_tdi jtag_tdo jtag_emu0 gpio_11 safe_mode AA10 NA jtag_emu1 gpio_31 safe_mode AF10 NA etk_clk mcbsp5_ clkx mmc3_clk
7 0 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 2 O IO O H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO H H 0 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS I I O IO I O IO IO L L L H H L H L L 0 H H Z H 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds Yes Yes NA Yes Yes NA Yes NA NA 4 4 NA 4 4 PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS O IO L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS O IO L L 7(14) vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS O IO 0 L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS I O IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS I O O IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS I O O IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS I O IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS I IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS I IO IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS I IO IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
39
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
hsusb1_stp gpio_12 mm1_rxdp hw_dbg0 AE10 NA etk_ctl mmc3_cmd hsusb1_clk gpio_13 hw_dbg1 AF11 NA etk_d0 mcspi3_ simo mmc3_dat4 hsusb1_ data0 gpio_14 mm1_rxrcv hw_dbg2 AG12 NA etk_d1 mcspi3_ somi hsusb1_ data1 gpio_15 mm1_txse0 hw_dbg3 AH12 NA etk_d2 mcspi3_cs0 hsusb1_ data2 gpio_16 mm1_txdat hw_dbg4 AE13 NA etk_d3 mcspi3_clk mmc3_dat3 hsusb1_ data7 gpio_17 hw_dbg5 AE11 NA etk_d4 mcbsp5_dr mmc3_dat0 hsusb1_ data4 gpio_18 hw_dbg6 AH9 NA etk_d5 mcbsp5_fsx mmc3_dat1 hsusb1_ data5 gpio_19 hw_dbg7 AF13 NA etk_d6 mcbsp5_dx mmc3_dat2 hsusb1_ data6 gpio_20 hw_dbg8 AH14 NA etk_d7 mcspi3_cs1
3 4 5 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 7 0 1 3 4 5 7 0 1 3 4 5 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1
O IO IO O O IO O IO O O IO IO IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO O O I IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO O O O IO IO IO O O O L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
40
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
mmc3_dat7 hsusb1_ data3 gpio_21 mm1_txen_n hw_dbg9 AF9 NA etk_d8 mmc3_dat6 hsusb1_dir gpio_22 hw_dbg10 AG9 NA etk_d9 mmc3_dat5 hsusb1_nxt gpio_23 mm1_rxdm hw_dbg11 AE7 NA etk_d10 uart1_rx hsusb2_clk gpio_24 hw_dbg12 AF7 NA etk_d11 hsusb2_stp gpio_25 mm2_rxdp hw_dbg13 AG7 NA etk_d12 hsusb2_dir gpio_26 hw_dbg14 AH7 NA etk_d13 hsusb2_nxt gpio_27 mm2_rxdm hw_dbg15 AG8 NA etk_d14 hsusb2_ data0 gpio_28 mm2_rxrcv hw_dbg16 AH8 NA etk_d15 hsusb2_ data1 gpio_29 mm2_txse0 hw_dbg17 AH21 AG16 M28 AH20 AG20 AG21 H28 P25 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA vss vss vss cap_vddu_array vdds vdds vdds vdds_x
2 3 4 5 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 5 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 3 4 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
IO IO IO IO O O IO I IO O O IO I IO IO O O I O IO O O O IO IO O O I IO O O I IO IO O O IO IO IO O O IO IO IO O GND GND GND PWR PWR PWR PWR PWR L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
41
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
AE9, AE18, NA AE19, AE24, AC4, Y16, Y18, Y19, Y20, W18, W20, V20, U19, U20, T19, P20, N19, N20, M19, M25, L25, K18, K20, J4, J18, J19, J20, H4, E25, D8, D9, D15, D22, D23 Y9, Y10, NA Y11, Y14, Y15, W9, W11, W12, W15, U10, T9, T10, R9, R10, N10, M9, M10, L9, L10, K11, K14, K13, J9, J10, J11, J14, J15 AH6, U1, R4, J1, J2, G28, F1, F2, D16, C16, C28, B5, B8, B12, B18, B22, A5, A8, A12, A18, A22
vdd_core
PWR
vdd_mpu_iva
PWR
AC5, P1, vdds_mem H1, F23, E1, C23, A4, A7, A10, A15, A18
PWR
AG27, AF8, NA AF16, AF23, AE8, AE16, AE23, AD3, AD4, W4, F25, F26 W16 K15 AA16 AA14 K25 V25 Y26 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
vdds
PWR
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
42
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
B4, B7, B10, vss B15, B18, C22, E2, F22, H2, P2, AB5, AB14, AB20
GND
NA
cap_vddu_wkup_ logic
0 -
PWR -
A12, AA1, Feed-Through AA23, AB11, Pins(9) AB9, AC11, AC13, AC14, AC8, AC9, H23, K1, L1, U1, Y23, A1, A2, A22, A23, AB1, AB23, AC1, AC2, AC22, AC23, B1, B23, AA2, U2, AA22, AB8, AB13, B12, H22, K2, K22, L2
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
43
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
G1, A13, AB2, AB22, No Connect(2) A14,A16, B2, B22 A17, B14, B16, B17, C14, C15, C17, D17, D18, H9, H10, H11, H12, H13, H14, H15, H16, H17, A4, A6, A7, A9, A10, A11, A19, A20, A21, B3, B4, B6, B7, B9, B10, B11, B13, B19, B20, B21, C1,C2, C3, C4,C5, C6, C8,C9, C11, C12, C18, C20, C21, D1, D2, D3, D4, D5,D6, D11, D12,D14, D20, E1,E2, AA26, AE27 Y17 U4 V4 L21 NA NA NA NA sys_xtalgnd cap_vdd_bb_ mpu_iva cap_vdd_sram _mpu_iva
0 0 0
cap_vdd_sram_core 0
(1) The usage of this GPIO is strongly restricted. For more information, see the GPIO chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (2) Pins labeled as "No connect" must be left unconnected. Any connections to these pins may result in unpredictable behavior. (3) NA in this table stands for "Not Applicable". (4) The drive strength is fixed regardless of the load. The driver is designed to drive 75-ohm for video applications. (5) PU = [50 to 100 k] per default or [10 to 50 k] according to the selected mode. For a full description of the pull-up drive strength programming, see the PRG_SDMMC_PUSTRENGTH configuration register bit field in the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). PD: 30 to 150 k. (6) The pullup and pulldown can be either the standard LVCMOS 100-A drive strength or the I2C pullup and pulldown described below: Nominal resistance = 1.66 k in high-speed mode with a load range of 5 pF to 12 pF, 4.5 k in standard / fast mode with a load range of 5 pF to 15 pF. (7) The default buffer configuration is High-Speed I2C point-to-point mode using internal pullup. For a full description of the pull drive strength programming, see prg_i2c1_pullupresx, prg_i2c1_lb1lb0, and prg_sr_pullupresx, prg_sr_lb bits of the CONTROL_PROG_IO1, CONTROL_PROG_IO_WKUP1 control modules in the System Control Module / SCM Programming Model / Feature Settings section and the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4) to modify the IO settings if required by the targeted interface application. (8) The default buffer configuration is standard LVCMOS mode (non-I2C). For a full description of the pull drive strength programming, see PADCONFS bits of CONTROL_PADCONF_X control modules (standard LVCMOS mode), or prg_i2c2_pullupresx, prg_i2c2_lb1lb0, and prg_i2c3_pullupresx, prg_i2c3_lb1lb0 bits of the CONTROL_PROG_IO2, CONTROL_PROG_IO3 control modules (I2C mode) in the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4) to modify the IO settings if required by the targeted interface application. (9) These signals are feed-through balls. For more information, see Table 2-28. (10) In buffer mode, the drive strength is fixed regardless of the load. The driver is designed to drive 75 for video applications. In bypass mode, the drive strength is 0.47 mA. (11) Depending on the sys_clkreq direction the corresponding reset released state value can be: Z if sys_clkreq is used as input 1 if sys_clkreq is used as output For a full description of the sys_clkreq control, see Power, Reset, and Clock Management chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (12) The drive strength of these IOs is set according to the programmable load range: 2 pF to 4 pF per default or 4 pF to 12 pF. For a full description of the drive strength programming, see the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical 44 TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (13) In the safe_mode_out1, the buffer is configured to drive 1. (14) Mux0 if sys_boot6 is pulled down (clock master). (15) If MMC1 functional signals are enabled, vdds_mmc1 for MMC1 must be supplied by a dedicated power source. If MMC1 functional signals are disabled, other multiplexed CMOS signals of the interface can be enabled. The interface can be supplied by the same power source as vdds. The vdds power source supplies the vdds_mmc1 ball. If neither MMC1 functional balls or CMOS signals are enabled, the interface balls are left unconnected with its associated power supply (vdda/vssa) grounded. For the corresponding setting of the PBIASLITEPWRDNZ0 bit, see the System Control Module / SCM Programming Model / Extended-Drain I/Os and PBIAS Cells Programming Guide section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
0 4 7 0 4 7 4 7 4 7 4 7 4 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 0 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
I I I I I I I I O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O
AE15
NA
vdda
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AD17
NA
gpio_112 safe_mode
vdda
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AE18
NA
gpio_114 safe_mode
vdda
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AD16
NA
vdda
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AE17 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
NA G20 K20 J20 J21 U21 R20 M21 M20 N20 K21 Y16 N21 R21 AA15 Y12 AA18 V20 Y15
safe_mode sdrc_a0 sdrc_a1 sdrc_a2 sdrc_a3 sdrc_a4 sdrc_a5 sdrc_a6 sdrc_a7 sdrc_a8 sdrc_a9 sdrc_a10 sdrc_a11 sdrc_a12 sdrc_a13 sdrc_a14 sdrc_ba0 sdrc_ba1 sdrc_cke0 safe_mode_out1(6)
L 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 H
L 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7
vdda vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds
Yes NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
NA 4
(1)
PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD
LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS
4(1) 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4
(1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1)
4(1) 4 4 4 4
(1) (1) (1) (1)
4(1) 4
(1)
NA
Y13
sdrc_cke1 safe_mode_out1(6)
vdds
NA
(1)
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
A12 D1 G1 G2 E1 D2 E2 B3
IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO
L L L L L L L L
0 Z Z Z Z Z Z Z
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
4 4 4 4
4(1) 4 4 4
(1) (1) (1)
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
45
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
IO CELL [12] LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS
sdrc_d7 sdrc_d8 sdrc_d9 sdrc_d10 sdrc_d11 sdrc_d12 sdrc_d13 sdrc_d14 sdrc_d15 sdrc_d16 sdrc_d17 sdrc_d18 sdrc_d19 sdrc_d20 sdrc_d21 sdrc_d22 sdrc_d23 sdrc_d24 sdrc_d25 sdrc_d26 sdrc_d27 sdrc_d28 sdrc_d29 sdrc_d30 sdrc_d31 sdrc_dm0 sdrc_dm1 sdrc_dm2 sdrc_dm3 sdrc_dqs0 sdrc_dqs1 sdrc_dqs2 sdrc_dqs3 sdrc_ncas sdrc_nclk sdrc_ncs0 sdrc_ncs1 sdrc_nras sdrc_nwe dss_data0 uart1_cts gpio_70 safe_mode
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2
IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O O O O IO IO IO IO O O O O O O IO I IO IO O IO IO IO IO IO IO I
PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD
4(1) 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4
(1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1)
4(1) 4 4 4 4 4 4
(1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1)
4(1) 4 4
(1) (1)
4(1) 4 4
(1) (1)
4(1) 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 8 NA 8 8
(1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1) (1)
AE22
NA
vdda
Yes
8 8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AE23
NA
vdda
Yes
8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AE24
NA
vdda
Yes
8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AD23
NA
dss_data4 uart3_rx_irrx
vdda
Yes
8 NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
46
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
gpio_74 safe_mode AD24 NA dss_data5 uart3_tx_irtx gpio_75 safe_mode AC26 NA dss_data10 gpio_80 safe_mode AD26 NA dss_data11 gpio_81 safe_mode AA25 NA dss_data12 gpio_82 safe_mode Y25 NA dss_data13 gpio_83 safe_mode AA26 NA dss_data14 gpio_84 safe_mode AB26 NA dss_data15 gpio_85 safe_mode F25 NA dss_data20 mcspi3_somi dss_data2 gpio_90 safe_mode AC25 NA dss_data22 mcspi3_cs1 dss_data4 gpio_92 safe_mode AB25 NA dss_data23 dss_data5 gpio_93 safe_mode G25 NA dss_pclk gpio_66 hw_dbg12 safe_mode J2 NA gpmc_a1 gpio_34 safe_mode H1 NA gpmc_a2 gpio_35 safe_mode H2 NA gpmc_a3 gpio_36 safe_mode G2 NA gpmc_a4 gpio_37 safe_mode F1 NA gpmc_a5
4 7 0 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0
IO IO O IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O IO IO IO O O IO IO O IO IO O IO O O IO O IO O IO O IO O L L 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes H H 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes H H 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes L L 7 vdds Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
47
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
gpio_38 safe_mode F2 NA gpmc_a6 gpio_39 safe_mode E1 NA gpmc_a7 gpio_40 safe_mode E2 NA gpmc_a8 gpio_41 safe_mode D1 NA gpmc_a9 sys_ndmareq2 gpio_42 safe_mode D2 NA gpmc_a10 sys_ndmareq3 gpio_43 safe_mode N1 L1 gpmc_clk gpio_59 safe_mode AA2 AA1 AC2 AC1 AE5 AD6 AD5 AC5 V1 U2 U1 V2 V1 AA3 AA4 Y3 Y4 R1 gpmc_d0 gpmc_d1 gpmc_d2 gpmc_d3 gpmc_d4 gpmc_d5 gpmc_d6 gpmc_d7 gpmc_d8 gpio_44 safe_mode Y1 T1 gpmc_d9 gpio_45 safe_mode T1 N1 gpmc_d10 gpio_46 safe_mode U2 P2 gpmc_d11 gpio_47 safe_mode U1 P1 gpmc_d12 gpio_48 safe_mode P1 M1 gpmc_d13 gpio_49 safe_mode L2 J2 gpmc_d14 gpio_50 safe_mode M2 K2 gpmc_d15 gpio_51 safe_mode AD10 AA9 gpmc_nadv_ale
4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0
IO O IO O IO O IO O I IO O I IO O IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O 0 0 0 vdds NA 8 NA LVCMOS H H 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS L 0 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS
48
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 0 0 4 7 0 0 4 7 0 2 4 7 0
O IO O IO O O IO O IO O I IO O I IO IO IO O I I IO IO O I IO IO IO O O IO IO IO O O O IO I I IO I O IO I
J1
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
AD8 AD1
AA8 W1
1 H
1 1
0 0
vdds vdds
NA Yes
8 8
NA PU/ PD
LVCMOS LVCMOS
A3
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
B6
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
B4
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C4
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
B5
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C5
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
N2 M1 AC6
L2 K1 Y5
1 1 L
1 1 0
0 0 0
NA NA Yes
8 8 8
NA NA PU/ PD
AC11 AC8
Y10 Y8
H H
H H
0 7
vdds vdds
Yes Yes
NA 8
PU/ PD PU/ PD
LVCMOS LVCMOS
B3
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C6
NA
gpmc_wait3
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
49
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
sys_ndmareq1 uart4_rx gpio_65 safe_mode W19 NA hsusb0_clk gpio_120 safe_mode V20 NA hsusb0_data0 uart3_tx_irtx gpio_125 uart2_tx safe_mode Y20 NA hsusb0_data1 uart3_rx_irrx gpio_130 uart2_rx safe_mode V18 NA hsusb0_data2 uart3_rts_sd gpio_131 uart2_rts safe_mode W20 NA hsusb0_data3 uart3_cts_rctx gpio_169 uart2_cts safe_mode W17 NA hsusb0_data4 gpio_188 safe_mode Y18 NA hsusb0_data5 gpio_189 safe_mode Y19 NA hsusb0_data6 gpio_190 safe_mode Y17 NA hsusb0_data7 gpio_191 safe_mode V19 NA hsusb0_dir gpio_122 safe_mode W18 NA hsusb0_nxt gpio_124 safe_mode U20 NA hsusb0_stp gpio_121 safe_mode U15 W13 V14 U16 Y13 V15 NA NA NA NA NA NA jtag_ntrst jtag_rtck jtag_tck jtag_tdi jtag_tdo jtag_tms_tmsc
1 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 0 0 0
I I IO I IO IO O IO O IO I IO I IO O IO O IO IO IO I IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO I IO I IO O IO I O I I O IO L L L H L H L 0 L H Z H 0 0 0 0 0 0 vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds Yes NA Yes Yes NA Yes NA 4 NA NA 4 4 PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS
50
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
BUFFER PULLUP STRENGTH /DOWN (mA) [10] TYPE [11] 1 PU/ PD(3)
0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 4 7 4 7 4 7 4 7 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 2 4 7
L18
NA
vdds_mmc1( Yes
13)
PU/ PD(3)
LVCMOS
M19
NA
vdds_mmc1( Yes
13)
PU/ PD(3)
LVCMOS
M18
NA
vdds_mmc1( Yes
13)
PU/ PD(3)
LVCMOS
K18
NA
vdds_mmc1( Yes
13)
PU/ PD(3)
LVCMOS
N20
NA
vdds_mmc1( Yes
13)
PU/ PD(3)
LVCMOS
M20
NA
gpio_126(8) safe_mode
vdds_x
Yes
PU/PD(3)
LVCMOS
P17
NA
gpio_127(8) safe_mode
vdds_x
Yes
PU/PD(3)
LVCMOS
P18
NA
gpio_128 safe_mode
vdds
Yes
PU/PD
LVCMOS
P19
NA
gpio_129(8) safe_mode
vdds_x
Yes
PU/PD
(3)
LVCMOS
J25 J24 C2
NA NA NA
H H H
H H H
0 0 7
NA Yes Yes
3 3 3 4 4
PU/ PD(9) (10) Open Drain PU/ PD(9) (10) LVCMOS Open Drain PU/ PD(9)(11) LVCMOS Open Drain
C1
NA
vdds
Yes
3 4 4
AB4
NA
vdds
Yes
3 4 4
AC4
NA
vdds
Yes
3 4 4
U19
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
T17
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
51
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
0 1 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 3 4 7
I IO I IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO I IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO -
U17
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
V17
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
P20
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R18
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
T18
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R19
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
U18
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
P9
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R7
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R9
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
P8
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
P7
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
W7
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
52
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 4 7 0
IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O IO IO IO IO IO O IO IO O IO I IO IO IO O IO I
W8
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
U8
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
W10
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R10
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
T10
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
T9
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
U10
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
U9
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
V10
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
R2
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
H3
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
L4
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
Y24
NA
uart2_cts
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
53
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
mcbsp3_dx gpt_9_pwm_evt gpio_144 safe_mode AA24 NA uart2_rts mcbsp3_dr gpt_10_pwm_evt gpio_145 safe_mode AD21 NA uart2_rx mcbsp3_fsx gpt_8_pwm_evt gpio_147 safe_mode AD22 NA uart2_tx mcbsp3_clkx gpt_11_pwm_evt gpio_146 safe_mode F23 NA uart3_cts_rctx gpio_163 safe_mode F24 NA uart3_rts_sd gpio_164 safe_mode H24 NA uart3_rx_irrx gpio_165 safe_mode G24 NA uart3_tx_irtx gpio_166 safe_mode J23 NA hdq_sio sys_altclk i2c2_sccbe i2c3_sccbe gpio_170 safe_mode AD15 NA i2c4_scl sys_nvmode1 safe_mode W16 NA i2c4_sda sys_nvmode2 safe_mode F3 NA sys_boot0 dss_data18 gpio_2 safe_mode D3 NA sys_boot1 dss_data19 gpio_3 safe_mode C3 NA sys_boot2 gpio_4
1 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 7 0 1 7 0 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 4
IO IO IO O I IO IO I IO IO IO O IO IO IO IO IO O IO I IO O IO IOD I OD OD IO OD O IOD O I IO IO I IO IO I IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS Z Z 0 vdds Yes H H 0 vdds Yes H H 0 vdds Yes 3 4 4 3 4 4 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS PU/ PD(9) (10) LVCMOS Open Drain PU/ PD(9) (10) LVCMOS Open Drain H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS Open Drain H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
54
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
safe_mode E3 NA sys_boot3 dss_data20 gpio_5 safe_mode E4 NA sys_boot4 mmc2_dir_dat2 dss_data21 gpio_6 safe_mode G3 NA sys_boot5 mmc2_dir_dat3 dss_data22 gpio_7 safe_mode D4 NA sys_boot6 dss_data23 gpio_8 safe_mode AE14 NA sys_clkout1 gpio_10 safe_mode W11 NA sys_clkout2 gpio_186 safe_mode W15 NA sys_clkreq gpio_1 safe_mode V16 NA sys_nirq gpio_0 safe_mode V13 AD7 NA AA5 sys_nrespwron sys_nreswarm gpio_30 safe_mode V12 NA sys_off_mode gpio_9 safe_mode AF19 AF20 W26 V26 W25 U24 V23 AE20 A24 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA sys_xtalin sys_xtalout cvideo1_out cvideo2_out cvideo1_vfb cvideo2_vfb cvideo1_rset sys_32k cam_d2 gpio_101 hw_dbg4 safe_mode B24 NA cam_d3 gpio_102 hw_dbg5 safe_mode
7 0 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7
I O IO I O O IO I O O IO I O IO O IO O IO IO IO I IO I IOD IO O IO AI AO AO AO AO AO AIO I I IO O I IO O L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS Z Z 0 0 0 0 Z Z L Z 0 0 0 NA NA NA Z L 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 vdds vdds vdda_dac vdda_dac vdda_dac vdda_dac vdda_dac vdds vdds Yes NA NA NA NA NA No Yes Yes NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 8 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA PU/ PD PU/ PD LVCMOS Analog Analog 10-bit DAC 10-bit DAC 10-bit DAC 10-bit DAC 10-bit DAC LVCMOS LVCMOS 0 L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS Z 0 Z H 0 0 vdds vdds Yes Yes NA 4 No PU/ PD LVCMOS LVCMOS Open Drain H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS 0 see (7) 0 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7(12) vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
55
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 5 7
I IO O I IO O I IO O I IO O IO IO IO O IO IO O I IO O O IO O O IO O IO I I I I I I I I IO IO O -
C24
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
D25
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
E26
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
B23
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C23
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C26
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
D26
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
C25
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
E25
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
P25
NA
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
SubLVDS
P26
NA
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
SubLVDS
N25
NA
vdds
NA
NA
PU/ PD
SubLVDS
N26
NA
vdds
NA
NA
PU/ PD
SubLVDS
D23
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
56
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
0 2 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 4 5 7 0 4
I O IO O O IO IO O IO O IO I IO O IO I IO O IO O IO O IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O IO IO IO O IO O O IO
F26
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
G26
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
H25
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
H26
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
J26
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
L25
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
L26
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
M24
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
M26
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
N24
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
K24
NA
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
M25
NA
dss_vsync gpio_68
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
57
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
safe_mode R8 NA mcspi1_cs1 mmc3_cmd gpio_175 safe_mode T8 NA mcspi1_cs3 hsusb2_data2 gpio_177 mm2_txdat safe_mode V9 NA mcspi2_cs1 gpt_8_pwm_evt hsusb2_data3 gpio_182 mm2_txen_n safe_mode T19 NA mcbsp_clks cam_shutter gpio_160 uart1_cts safe_mode AB2 NA etk_clk mcbsp5_clkx mmc3_clk hsusb1_stp gpio_12 mm1_rxdp hw_dbg0 AB3 NA etk_ctl mmc3_cmd hsusb1_clk gpio_13 hw_dbg1 AC3 NA etk_d0 mcspi3_simo mmc3_dat4 hsusb1_data0 gpio_14 mm1_rxrcv hw_dbg2 AD4 NA etk_d1 mcspi3_somi hsusb1_data1 gpio_15 mm1_txse0 hw_dbg3 AD3 NA etk_d2 mcspi3_cs0 hsusb1_data2 gpio_16 mm1_txdat hw_dbg4 AA3 NA etk_d3 mcspi3_clk mmc3_dat3
7 0 3 4 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 1 3 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 7 0 1 3 4 5 7 0 1 3 4 5 7 0 1 2
O IO IO O IO IO IO O IO IO IO IO I O IO I O IO O O IO IO O O IO O IO O O IO IO IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO O O IO IO H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
58
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
hsusb1_data7 gpio_17 hw_dbg5 Y3 NA etk_d4 mcbsp5_dr mmc3_dat0 hsusb1_data4 gpio_18 hw_dbg6 AB1 NA etk_d5 mcbsp5_fsx mmc3_dat1 hsusb1_data5 gpio_19 hw_dbg7 AE3 NA etk_d6 mcbsp5_dx mmc3_dat2 hsusb1_data6 gpio_20 hw_dbg8 AD2 NA etk_d7 mcspi3_cs1 mmc3_dat7 hsusb1_data3 gpio_21 mm1_txen_n hw_dbg9 AA4 NA etk_d8 mmc3_dat6 hsusb1_dir gpio_22 hw_dbg10 V2 NA etk_d9 mmc3_dat5 hsusb1_nxt gpio_23 mm1_rxdm hw_dbg11 AE4 NA etk_d10 uart1_rx hsusb2_clk gpio_24 hw_dbg12 AF6 NA etk_d11 hsusb2_stp gpio_25 mm2_rxdp hw_dbg13 AE6 NA etk_d12 hsusb2_dir gpio_26 hw_dbg14 AF7 NA etk_d13 hsusb2_nxt
3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 5 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 3 4 7 0 3
IO IO O O I IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO O O O IO IO IO O O O IO IO IO IO O O IO I IO O O IO I IO IO O O I O IO O O O IO IO O O I IO O O I L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
59
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
gpio_27 mm2_rxdm hw_dbg15 AF9 NA etk_d14 hsusb2_data0 gpio_28 mm2_rxrcv hw_dbg16 AE9 NA etk_d15 hsusb2_data1 gpio_29 mm2_txse0 hw_dbg17 Y15 NA jtag_emu0 gpio_11 safe_mode Y14 NA jtag_emu1 gpio_31 safe_mode U3 NA mcbsp3_clkx uart2_tx gpio_142 safe_mode N3 NA mcbsp3_dr uart2_rts gpio_141 safe_mode P3 NA mcbsp3_dx uart2_cts gpio_140 safe_mode W3 NA mcbsp3_fsx uart2_rx gpio_143 safe_mode V3 NA mcbsp4_clkx gpio_152 mm3_txse0 safe_mode U4 NA mcbsp4_dr gpio_153 mm3_rxrcv safe_mode R3 NA mcbsp4_dx gpio_154 mm3_txdat safe_mode T3 NA mcbsp4_fsx gpio_155 mm3_txen_n safe_mode M3 NA mmc2_dat5 mmc2_dir_dat1 cam_global_reset mmc3_dat1
4 5 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 4 6 7 0 4 6 7 0 4 6 7 0 4 6 7 0 1 2 3
IO IO O O IO IO IO O O IO IO IO O IO IO IO IO IO O IO I O IO IO I IO IO I IO IO IO IO I IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 0 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 0 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
60
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
gpio_137 mm3_rxdp safe_mode L3 NA mmc2_dat6 mmc2_dir_cmd cam_shutter mmc3_dat2 gpio_138 safe_mode K3 NA mmc2_dat7 mmc2_clkin mmc3_dat3 gpio_139 mm3_rxdm safe_mode W2 NA uart1_cts gpio_150 safe_mode AC16 AD18 L19 AC19 AD19 L20 P23 AE19 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA vss vdds vss vss vdds vdds vdds_x cap_vddu_array vdd_core
4 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 6 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
IO IO IO O O IO IO IO I IO IO IO I IO GND PWR GND GND PWR PWR PWR PWR PWR L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
AC21, D15, NA G11, G18, H20, M7, M17, R20, T7, Y8, Y12 D13, G9, NA G12, H7, K11, L9, M9, M10, N7, N8, P10, U7, U11, U13, V7, V11, W9, Y9, Y11
vdd_mpu_iva
PWR
A18, AC7, A3, A15, B5, vdds AC15, F2, F21, AC18, L20, W21 AC24, AD20, AE10, C11, D9, E24, G4, J15, J18, L7, L24, M4, T4, T24, W24, Y4, AB24 U12 K13 U14 W14 N23 V25 V24 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA vdds_sram vdda_dplls_dll vdda_dpll_per vdda_wkup_bg_bb vdds_mmc1 vdda_dac vssa_dac
PWR
0 0 0 0 0 0 0
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
61
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
A7, A13, vss B14, C1, F1, F20, H2, H20, L21, M2, P20, R2, W20 Y6, Y11, AA7, AA16
GND
NA
cap_vddu_wkup_log 0 ic -
PWR -
A1, J1, N2, Feed-Through T2, W2, Y2, Pins(4) AA6, Y7, Y9, AA10, AA11, AA12, AA13, Y14, AA14, B16, Y17, AA17, Y19, AA19, A20, Y20, AA20, A21, B21, H21, P21, Y21, AA21
62
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
A2, AF1, A2, AA1, No Connect(2) B1,D5, K23, AA2,B1, B2, A5, A7, A9, B20, Y1 A10, A11, A12, A14, A15, A16, A17, A19, A21, A22, AA23, AB23, AC9, AC12, AC13, AC14, AC17, AC20, AC22, AC23, AD9, AD11, AD12, AD13, AE1, AE8, AE11, AE12, AE13, AF2, AF3, AF11, B7, B8, B9, B10, B11, B12, B13, B14, B15, B16, B17, B18, B19, B20, B21, B22, C7, C8, C9, C10, C13, C14, C15, C16, C17 C18, C19, C20, C21, C22, D8, D11, D16, D17, D19, D21, D22, E23, F4, G7, G13, G14, G15, G16, G17, G19, H8, H9, H10, H11, H12, H13, H14, H15, H16, H17, H18, H19, H23, J3, J4, J7, J8, J9, J10, J11, J12, J13, J14, J16, J17, J19, J20, K4, K7, K8, K9, K10, K12, K16, K17, K19, L8, M8, M23, N18, P2, P4, P24, R23, R24, R25, R26, T25, T26, U23, V4, W12, Y23 AF23 A4 NA NA sys_xtalgnd gpmc_a11 safe_mode D6 N9 K20 NA NA NA
0 0 7
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
63
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) The drive strength of these IOs is set according to the programmable load range: 2 pF to 4 pF per default or 4 pF to 12 pF. For a full description of the drive strength programming, see the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (2) Pins labeled as "No connect" must be left unconnected. Any connections to these pins may result in unpredictable behavior. (3) PU = [50 to 100 k] per default or [10 to 50 k] according to the selected mode. For a full description of the pull-up drive strength programming, see the PRG_SDMMC_PUSTRENGTH configuration register bit field in the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). PD: 30 to 150 k. (4) These signals are feed-through balls. For more information, see Table 2-27. (5) NA in this table stands for "Not Applicable". (6) In the safe_mode_out1, the buffer is configured to drive 1. (7) Depending on the sys_clkreq direction the corresponding reset released state value can be: Z if sys_clkreq is used as input 1 if sys_clkreq is used as output For a full description of the sys_clkreq control, see Power, Reset, and Clock Management chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (8) The usage of this GPIO is strongly restricted. For more information, see the General-Purpose Interface chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (9) The pullup and pulldown can be either the standard LVCMOS 100-A drive strength or the I2C pullup and pulldown described as follows: Nominal resistance = 1.66 k in high-speed mode with a load range of 5 pF to 12 pF, 4.5 k in standard / fast mode with a load range of 5 pF to 15 pF. (10) The default buffer configuration is High-Speed I2C point-to-point mode using internal pullup. For a full description of the pull drive strength programming, see prg_i2c1_pullupresx, prg_i2c1_lb1lb0, and prg_sr_pullupresx, prg_sr_lb bits of the CONTROL_PROG_IO1, CONTROL_PROG_IO_WKUP1 control modules in the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4) to modify the IO settings if required by the targeted interface application. (11) The default buffer configuration is standard LVCMOS mode (non-I2C). For a full description of the pull drive strength programming, see PADCONFS bits of CONTROL_PADCONF_X control modules (standard LVCMOS mode), or prg_i2c2_pullupresx, prg_i2c2_lb1lb0, and prg_i2c3_pullupresx, prg_i2c3_lb1lb0 bits of the CONTROL_PROG_IO2, CONTROL_PROG_IO3 control modules (I2C mode) in the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4) to modify the IO settings if required by the targeted interface application. (12) Mux0 if sys_boot6 is pulled down (clock master). (13) If MMC1 functional signals are enabled, vdds_mmc1 for MMC1 must be supplied by a dedicated power source. If MMC1 functional signals are disabled, other multiplexed CMOS signals of the interface can be enabled. The interface can be supplied by the same power source as vdds. The vdds power source supplies the vdds_mmc1 ball. If neither MMC1 functional balls or CMOS signals are enabled, the interface balls are left unconnected with its associated power supply (vdda/vssa) grounded. For the corresponding setting of the PBIASLITEPWRDNZ0 bit, see the System Control Module / SCM Programming Model / Extended-Drain I/Os and PBIAS Cells Programming Guide section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO
Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS
64
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
PULLUP /DOWN TYPE [11] PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD
IO CELL [12]
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7 0 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 7 0
IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O IO O O
Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA Yes NA NA
LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS
4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8) 4(8)
vdds_mem
NA
4(8)
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O O O O O O O IO IO IO IO O IO
1 1 1 0 0 0 0 L L L L L
1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Z Z Z Z L
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 7
vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem vdds_mem
4(8) 4(8) 4
(8)
PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD
LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
65
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0
IO
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O I IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O I IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO
H H H H H H H H H
H H H H H H H H H
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
66
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
4 7 0 4 7 0 0 1 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 1 2 4 7
IO
IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O O I IO
1 H
1 H
0 7
vdds_mem vdds_mem
NA Yes
8 8
NA PU/ PD
LVCMOS LVCMOS
O I IO IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O I I IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O I IO IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O O IO IO IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O O O O IO
0 1 1 L
0 1 1 0
0 0 0 0
NA NA NA Yes
8 8 8 8
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds_mem
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I I I I IO
H H
H H
0 7
vdds_mem vdds_mem
Yes Yes
NA 8
PU/ PD PU/ PD
LVCMOS LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
67
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5
O IO O
Yes
LVCMOS
O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO
vdds
Yes
8 NA 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO
vdds
Yes
8 8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO
vdds
Yes
8 NA 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO
vdds
Yes
8 8 8 8
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
68
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 AO 0 0 0 vdda_dac NA NA(6) NA 10-bit DAC O IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS O O IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS O IO IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS O IO IO IO H H 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
69
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
0 0 0 0 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 5 7 0 2 5 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7
AO AO AO AIO IO IO O
NA NA NA No Yes
IO IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I I
vdds
Yes
NA
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
70
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
0 4 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0
I I
Yes
LVCMOS
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO O
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds_mmc1(1 Yes
4)
PU/ PD (4)
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds_mmc1(1 Yes
4)
PU/ PD(4)
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds_mmc1(1 Yes
4)
PU/ PD(4)
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds_mmc1(1 Yes
4)
PU/ PD(4)
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds_mmc1(1 Yes
4)
PU/ PD(4)
LVCMOS
IO
vdds_mmc1(1 Yes
4)
PU/ PD(4)
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
71
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
4 7 4 7 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 6 7 0 1
IO
IO
vdds_x
Yes
PU/ PD(4)
LVCMOS
IO
vdds_x
Yes
PU/ PD (4)
LVCMOS
O IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O O IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
72
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 1 2 4 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 1 2 4
IO
I O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I O IO I
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
73
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
7 0 2 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 2 4 5 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO IO I L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO O IO O L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO I IO I L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO O IO O L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS I IO L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS I IO L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS O IO H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS I IO L L 7 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS O IO H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS I IO H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS O IO H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO H H 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO IO L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
74
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 7 0 1 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 1 4 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 3
IO IO
Yes
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
OD IOD OD IO
H H H
H H H
0 0 7
NA Yes Yes
3 3 3 4
PU/ PD(10)(11) Open Drain PU/ PD(10)(11) Open Drain PU/ PD(10)(12) Open Drain
IOD IO
vdds
Yes
3 4
OD IO
vdds
Yes
3 4
IOD IO
vdds
Yes
3 4
OD O
vdds
Yes
3 4
IOD O
vdds
Yes
3 4
IOD I OD OD IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
75
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 7 0 1 3 4 5 7 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 1 3 4
IO
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
O IO IO IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I AI AO IO IO
Z Z Z 0
Z Z 0 see (3)
0 0 0 0
NA NA NA 4
PU/ PD No NA PU/ PD
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IOD IO
Z 0
Z H
0 0
vdds vdds
Yes Yes
NA 4
No PU/ PD
LVCMOS LVCMOS
I IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
I O O IO
vdds
Yes
PU/ PD
LVCMOS
76
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
7 0 1 3 4 7 0 3 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 4 7 0 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 7 0 1 3 4 5 O IO O O IO IO O O IO O IO O O IO IO IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS IO IO H H 0 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS I I O IO I O IO IO L L L H H L H L L 0 H H Z H 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds vdds Yes Yes NA Yes Yes NA Yes NA NA 4 4 NA 4 4 PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD PU/ PD LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS LVCMOS O IO L L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS O IO L L 7(13) vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS O IO 0 L 7 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS I O IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS I O O IO Z Z 0 vdds Yes 8 PU/ PD LVCMOS
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
77
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
7 0 1 3 4 5 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 7 0 2 3 4 7 0 2 3 4 5 7 0 2 3 4 7 0
O O IO IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO O O I IO IO IO O O IO IO IO IO O O O IO IO IO O O O IO IO IO IO O O IO I IO O O IO I IO IO O O I O IO O O L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS H H 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
78
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
3 4 5 7 0 3 4 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 3 4 5 7 0 3 4 5 7 0
O IO IO O O I IO O O I IO IO O O IO IO IO O O IO IO IO O PWR L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS L L 4 vdds Yes 4 PU/ PD LVCMOS
PWR
F10, G9, vdd_mpu_iva G10, H9, H10, J9, J10, L11, L12, M6, M7, M8, M12, N6, N7, N8, R6, R7, R8, T7, T8, U12, U13, V12, V13, W12, W13 H8 vdds_x
PWR
0 0
PWR PWR
M17, M18, vdds M19, N17, N18, N19, U10, V9, V10, W9, W10, Y9 N24 Y12 U8 H17 G18 U17 AA12 AA13 vdds_mmc1 cap_vddu_ wkup_logic
0 0
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
79
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
H11, H14, vss H16, J11, J12, J13, J14, J15, J16, K10, K11, K14, K15, L8, L10, L13, L17, M9, M10, M11, M13, M16, N9, N10, N11, N12, N13, N14, N15, N16, P8, P10, P11, P12, P13, P14, P15, P17, R10, R11, R14, R15, T9, T10, T11, T12, T13, T14, T15, T16, U9, U11, U14, U15, U16, V15, V16 AD1, A1, A2, No Connect(2) B1 W15 sys_xtalgnd
GND
(1) NA in this table stands for "Not Applicable". (2) Pins labeled as "No connect" must be left unconnected. Any connections to these pins may result in unpredictable behavior. (3) Depending on the sys_clkreq direction the corresponding reset released state value can be: Z if sys_clkreq is used as input 1 if sys_clkreq is used as output For a full description of the sys_clkreq control, see Power, Reset, and Clock Management chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (4) PU = [50 to 100 k] per default or [10 to 50 k] according to the selected mode. For a full description of the pull-up drive strength programming, see the PRG_SDMMC_PUSTRENGTH configuration register bit field in the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). PD: 30 to 150 k. (5) The usage of this GPIO is strongly restricted. For more information, see the General-Purpose Interface chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (6) The drive strength is fixed regardless of the load. The driver is designed to drive 75 for video applications. (7) In buffer mode, the drive strength is fixed regardless of the load. The driver is designed to drive 75 for video applications. In bypass mode, the drive strength is 0.47 mA. (8) The drive strength of these IOs is set according to the programmable load range: 2 pF to 4 pF per default or 4 pF to 12 pF. For a full description of the drive strength programming, see the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (9) In the safe_mode_out1, the buffer is configured to drive 1. (10) The pullup and pulldown can be either the standard LVCMOS 100-A drive strength or the I2C pullup and pulldown described below: Nominal resistance = 1.66 k in high-speed mode with a load range of 5 pF to 12 pF, 4.5 k in standard / fast mode with a load range of 5 pF to 15 pF. (11) The default buffer configuration is High-Speed I2C point-to-point mode using internal pullup. For a full description of the pull drive strength programming, see prg_i2c1_pullupresx, prg_i2c1_lb1lb0, and prg_sr_pullupresx, prg_sr_lb bits of the CONTROL_PROG_IO1, CONTROL_PROG_IO_WKUP1 control modules in the System Control Module / SCM Programming Model / Feature Settings section and the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4) to modify the IO settings if required by the targeted interface application. (12) The default buffer configuration is standard LVCMOS mode (non-I2C). For a full description of the pull drive strength programming, see PADCONFS bits of CONTROL_PADCONF_X control modules (standard LVCMOS mode), or prg_i2c2_pullupresx, prg_i2c2_lb1lb0, and prg_i2c3_pullupresx, prg_i2c3_lb1lb0 bits of the CONTROL_PROG_IO2, CONTROL_PROG_IO3 control modules (I2C mode) in the System Control Module chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4) to modify the IO settings if required by the targeted interface application. (13) Mux0 if sys_boot6 is pulled down (clock master). 80 TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(14) If MMC1 functional signals are enabled, vdds_mmc1 for MMC1 must be supplied by a dedicated power source. If MMC1 functional signals are disabled, other multiplexed CMOS signals of the interface can be enabled. The interface can be supplied by the same power source as vdds. The vdds power source supplies the vdds_mmc1 ball. If neither MMC1 functional balls or CMOS signals are enabled, the interface balls are left unconnected with its associated power supply (vdda/vssa) grounded. For the corresponding setting of the PBIASLITEPWRDNZ0 bit, see the System Control Module / SCM Programming Model / Extended-Drain I/Os and PBIAS Cells Programming Guide section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
81
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
2.4
Multiplexing Characteristics
Table 2-4 provides a description of the multiplexing on the CBP, CBC, and CUS packages, respectively. Note: The following does not take into account subsystem pin multiplexing options. Subsystem pin multiplexing options are described in Section 2.5, Signal Description. For more information, see the System Control Module / System Control Module Functional Description / Pad Functional Multiplexing and Configuration section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-4. Multiplexing Characteristics
CBP CBC Top J2 J1 G2 G1 F2 F1 D2 D1 B13 A13 B14 A14 B16 A16 B19 A19 B3 A3 B5 A5 B8 A8 B9 A9 B21 A21 D22 D23 E22 E23 G22 G23 AB21 AC21 N22 N23 P22 P23 R22 R23 T22 T23 U22 U23 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA Bottom D1 G1 G2 E1 D2 E2 B3 B4 A10 B11 A11 B12 A16 A17 B17 B18 B7 A5 B6 A6 A8 B9 A9 B10 C21 D20 B19 C20 D21 E20 E21 G21 AA18 V20 G20 K20 J20 J21 U21 R20 M21 M20 N20 K21 Top D7 C5 C6 B5 D9 D10 C7 B7 B11 C12 B12 D13 C13 B14 A14 B15 C9 E12 B8 B9 C10 B10 D12 E13 E15 D15 C15 B16 C16 D16 B17 B18 C18 D18 A4 B4 D6 B3 B2 C3 E3 F6 E10 E9 sdrc_d0 sdrc_d1 sdrc_d2 sdrc_d3 sdrc_d4 sdrc_d5 sdrc_d6 sdrc_d7 sdrc_d8 sdrc_d9 sdrc_d10 sdrc_d11 sdrc_d12 sdrc_d13 sdrc_d14 sdrc_d15 sdrc_d16 sdrc_d17 sdrc_d18 sdrc_d19 sdrc_d20 sdrc_d21 sdrc_d22 sdrc_d23 sdrc_d24 sdrc_d25 sdrc_d26 sdrc_d27 sdrc_d28 sdrc_d29 sdrc_d30 sdrc_d31 sdrc_ba0 sdrc_ba1 sdrc_a0 sdrc_a1 sdrc_a2 sdrc_a3 sdrc_a4 sdrc_a5 sdrc_a6 sdrc_a7 sdrc_a8 sdrc_a9 CUS MODE 0 MODE 1 MODE 2 MODE 3 MODE 4 MODE 5 MODE 6 MODE 7
Bottom NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
82
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
83
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
84
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
85
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
86
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
87
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
mcspi1_simo mmc2_dat5 mcspi1_somi mmc2_dat6 mcspi1_cs0 mcspi1_cs1 mcspi1_cs2 mcspi1_cs3 mcspi2_clk mcspi2_simo gpt_9_pwm_e vt mcspi2_somi gpt_10_pwm_ evt mcspi2_cs0 mcspi2_cs1 sys_32k sys_xtalin sys_xtalout sys_clkreq sys_nirq sys_nrespwro n gpt_11_pwm_ evt gpt_8_pwm_e vt mmc2_dat7
hsusb2_dat gpio_177 a2 hsusb2_dat gpio_178 a7 hsusb2_dat gpio_179 a4 hsusb2_dat gpio_180 a5 hsusb2_dat gpio_181 a6 hsusb2_dat gpio_182 a3
gpio_1 gpio_0
safe_mo de safe_mo de
88
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
hsusb2_nxt gpio_27
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
89
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
AC4, J4, H4, NA D8, AE9, D9, D15, Y16, AE18, Y18, W18, K18, J18, AE19, Y19, U19, T19, N19, M19, J19, Y20, W20, V20, U20, P20, N20, K20, J20, D22, D23, AE24, M25, L25, E25 Y9, W9, T9, NA R9, M9, L9, J9, Y10, U10, T10, R10, N10, M10, L10, J10, Y11, W11, K11, J11, W12, K13, Y14, K14, J14, Y15, W15, J15 U4 AA15 K15 W16 AD3, AD4, W4, AF8, AE8, AF16, AE16, AF23, AE23, F25, F26, AG27 NA NA NA NA NA
AC21, D15, NA G11, G18, H20, M7, M17, R20, T7, Y8, Y12
D13, G9, NA G12, H7, K11, L9, M9, M10, N7, N8, P10, U7, U11, U13, V7, V11, W9, Y9, Y11
F10, G9, G10, vdd_mpu_iva H9, H10, J9, J10, L11, L12, M6, M7, M8, M12, N6, N7, N8, R6, R7, R8, T7, T8, U12, U13, V12, V13, W12, W13
NA NA NA NA
A18, AC7, A3,A15,B5,F2 M17, M18, vdds AC15, AC18, ,F21,L20,W21 M19, N17, AC24, AD20, N18, N19, AE10, C11, U10, V9, V10, D9, E24, G4, W9, W10, Y9 J15, J18, L7, L24, M4, T4, T24, W24, Y4, AB24 NA E16, F15, vdds_mem F16, G15, G16, H15, J6, J7, J8, K6, K7, K8
U1, J1, F1, J2, F2, R4, B5, A5, AH6, B8, A8, B12, A12, D16, C16, B18, A18, B22, A22, G28, C28 AA16 AA14
AC5, P1, H1, NA F23, E1, C23, A4, A7, A10, A15, A18
NA NA
U14 W14
NA NA
U17 AA13
90
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
V25 V24 N23 P23 AD19 AE19 AC19 AC16 AD18 L19 L20 N9 K20 AF23
NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
vdda_dac vssa_dac vdds_mmc1 vdds_x vdds cap_vddu_arr ay vss vss vdds vss vdds cap_vdd_sra m_mpu_iva cap_vdd_sra m_core sys_xtalgnd
(1) This GPIO is only an input (and not an output). (2) The usage of this GPIO is strongly restricted. For more information, see the General-Purpose Interface chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (3) UART4 is only available on CBP and CBC packages.
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
91
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
2.5
Signal Description
Many signals are available on multiple pins according to the software configuration of the pin multiplexing options. 1. SIGNAL NAME: The signal name 2. DESCRIPTION: Description of the signal 3. TYPE: Type = Ball type for this specific function: I = Input O = Output Z = High-impedance D = Open Drain DS = Differential A = Analog 4. BALL BOTTOM: Associated ball(s) bottom 5. BALL TOP: Associated ball(s) top 6. SUBSYSTEM PIN MULTIPLEXING: Contains a list of the pin multiplexing options at the module/subsystem level. The pin function is selected at the module/system level. Note: The Subsystem Multiplexing Signals are not described in the following tables. For more information, see the System Control Module / System Control Module Functional Description / Pad Functional Multiplexing and Configuration section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
2.5.1
gpmc_a1
GPMC output address bit 1 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a17 GPMC output address bit 2 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a18 GPMC output address bit 3 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a19 GPMC output address bit 4 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a20 GPMC output address bit 5 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a21 GPMC output address bit 6 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a22 GPMC output address bit 7 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a23 GPMC output address bit 8 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a24
J2 / AA2
NA / U2
gpmc_a2
M4 / L1
AB15 / M1
H1 / AA1
NA / U1
K3 / M1
- / gpmc_d1
gpmc_a3
L4 / L2
AC16 / N2
H2 / AC2
NA / V2
K2 / M2
- / gpmc_d2
gpmc_a4
K4 / P2
AB16 / N1
G2 / AC1
NA / V1
J4 / N2
- / gpmc_d3
gpmc_a5
T3 / T1
AC17 / R2
F1 / AE5
NA / AA3
J3 / M3
- / gpmc_d4
gpmc_a6
R3 / V1
AB17 / R1
F2 / AD6
NA / AA4
J2/ P1
- / gpmc_d5
gpmc_a7
N3 / V2
AC18 / T2
E1 / AD5
NA / Y3
J1/ P2
- / gpmc_d6
gpmc_a8
M3 / W2
AB18 / T1
E2 / AC5
NA / Y4
H1/ R1
- / gpmc_d7
92
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
gpmc_a9
GPMC output address bit 9 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a25 GPMC output address bit 10 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a26 GPMC output address bit 11 / extended multiplexed address gpmc_a27 General-purpose memory address bit 12 General-purpose memory address bit 13 General-purpose memory address bit 14 General-purpose memory address bit 15 General-purpose memory address bit 16 General-purpose memory address bit 17 General-purpose memory address bit 18 General-purpose memory address bit 19 General-purpose memory address bit 20 General-purpose memory address bit 21 General-purpose memory address bit 22 General-purpose memory address bit 23 General-purpose memory address bit 24 General-purpose memory address bit 25 General-purpose memory address bit 26 GPMC data bit 0 / multiplexed address gpmc_a1 GPMC data bit 1 / multiplexed address gpmc_a2 GPMC data bit 2 / multiplexed address gpmc_a3 GPMC data bit 3 / multiplexed address gpmc_a4 GPMC data bit 4 / multiplexed address gpmc_a5 GPMC data bit 5 / multiplexed address gpmc_a6 GPMC data bit 6 / multiplexed address gpmc_a7 GPMC data bit 7 / multiplexed address gpmc_a8 GPMC data bit 8 / multiplexed address gpmc_a9 GPMC data bit 9 / multiplexed address gpmc_a10
D1 / V1
NA / R1
gpmc_a10
K3 / K2
D2 / Y1
T1
G2/ T2
- / gpmc_d9
gpmc_a11
NC / P1
A4 / T1
- / N1
NA
- / gpmc_d10
gpmc_a12 gpmc_a13 gpmc_a14 gpmc_a15 gpmc_a16 gpmc_a17 gpmc_a18 gpmc_a19 gpmc_a20 gpmc_a21 gpmc_a22 gpmc_a23 gpmc_a24 gpmc_a25 gpmc_a26 gpmc_d0 gpmc_d1 gpmc_d2 gpmc_d3 gpmc_d4 gpmc_d5 gpmc_d6 gpmc_d7 gpmc_d8 gpmc_d9
O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO
R1 R2 T2 W1 Y1 N4 M4 L4 K4 T3 R3 N3 M3 L3 K3 K1 L1 L2 P2 T1 V1 V2 W2 H2 K2
P2 P1 M1 J2 K2 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA U2 U1 V2 V1 AA3 AA4 Y3 Y4 R1 T1
R3 T3 U2 V1 V2 K4 K3 K2 J4 J3 J2 J1 H1 H2 G2 L2 M1 M2 N2 M3 P1 P2 R1 R2 T2
gpmc_d11 gpmc_d12 gpmc_d13 gpmc_d14 gpmc_d15 gpmc_a1 gpmc_a2 gpmc_a3 gpmc_a4 gpmc_a5 gpmc_a6 gpmc_a7 gpmc_a8 gpmc_a9 gpmc_a10 gpmc_d0 gpmc_d1 gpmc_d2 gpmc_d3 gpmc_d4 gpmc_d5 gpmc_d6 gpmc_d7 gpmc_d8 gpmc_d9
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
93
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
gpmc_d10 gpmc_d11 gpmc_d12 gpmc_d13 gpmc_d14 gpmc_d15 gpmc_ncs0 gpmc_ncs1 gpmc_ncs2 gpmc_ncs3 gpmc_ncs4 gpmc_ncs5 gpmc_ncs6 gpmc_ncs7 gpmc_io_dir gpmc_clk
GPMC data bit 10 / multiplexed address gpmc_a11 GPMC data bit 11 / multiplexed address gpmc_a12 GPMC data bit 12 / multiplexed address gpmc_a13 GPMC data bit 13 / multiplexed address gpmc_a14 GPMC data bit 14 / multiplexed address gpmc_a15 GPMC data bit 15 / multiplexed address gpmc_a16 GPMC Chip Select bit 0 GPMC Chip Select bit 1 GPMC Chip Select bit 2 GPMC Chip Select bit 3 GPMC Chip Select bit 4 GPMC Chip Select bit 5 GPMC Chip Select bit 6 GPMC Chip Select bit 7 GPMC IO direction control for use with external transceivers GPMC clock
IO IO IO IO IO IO O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O I I I I
gpmc_nadv_ale Address Valid or Address Latch Enable gpmc_noe gpmc_nwe Output Enable Write Enable
gpmc_nbe0_cle Lower Byte Enable. Also used for Command Latch Enable gpmc_nbe1 gpmc_nwp gpmc_wait0 gpmc_wait1 gpmc_wait2 gpmc_wait3 Upper Byte Enable Flash Write Protect External indication of wait External indication of wait External indication of wait External indication of wait
NOTE
For more information, see Memory Subsystem / SDRAM Controller (SDRC) Subsystem / SDRC Subsystem Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
94
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
sdrc_d0 sdrc_d1 sdrc_d2 sdrc_d3 sdrc_d4 sdrc_d5 sdrc_d6 sdrc_d7 sdrc_d8 sdrc_d9 sdrc_d10 sdrc_d11 sdrc_d12 sdrc_d13 sdrc_d14 sdrc_d15 sdrc_d16 sdrc_d17 sdrc_d18 sdrc_d19 sdrc_d20 sdrc_d21 sdrc_d22 sdrc_d23 sdrc_d24 sdrc_d25 sdrc_d26 sdrc_d27 sdrc_d28 sdrc_d29 sdrc_d30 sdrc_d31 sdrc_ba0 sdrc_ba1 sdrc_a0 sdrc_a1 sdrc_a2 sdrc_a3 sdrc_a4 sdrc_a5 sdrc_a6 sdrc_a7 sdrc_a8 sdrc_a9 sdrc_a10 sdrc_a11 sdrc_a12 sdrc_a13 sdrc_a14
SDRAM data bit 0 SDRAM data bit 1 SDRAM data bit 2 SDRAM data bit 3 SDRAM data bit 4 SDRAM data bit 5 SDRAM data bit 6 SDRAM data bit 7 SDRAM data bit 8 SDRAM data bit 9 SDRAM data bit 10 SDRAM data bit 11 SDRAM data bit 12 SDRAM data bit 13 SDRAM data bit 14 SDRAM data bit 15 SDRAM data bit 16 SDRAM data bit 17 SDRAM data bit 18 SDRAM data bit 19 SDRAM data bit 20 SDRAM data bit 21 SDRAM data bit 22 SDRAM data bit 23 SDRAM data bit 24 SDRAM data bit 25 SDRAM data bit 26 SDRAM data bit 27 SDRAM data bit 28 SDRAM data bit 29 SDRAM data bit 30 SDRAM data bit 31 SDRAM bank select 0 SDRAM bank select 1 SDRAM address bit 0 SDRAM address bit 1 SDRAM address bit 2 SDRAM address bit 3 SDRAM address bit 4 SDRAM address bit 5 SDRAM address bit 6 SDRAM address bit 7 SDRAM address bit 8 SDRAM address bit 9 SDRAM address bit 10 SDRAM address bit 11 SDRAM address bit 12 SDRAM address bit 13 SDRAM address bit 14
IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O
NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
D1 G1 G2 E1 D2 E2 B3 B4 A10 B11 A11 B12 A16 A17 B17 B18 B7 A5 B6 A6 A8 B9 A9 B10 C21 D20 B19 C20 D21 E20 E21 G21 AA18 V20 G20 K20 J20 J21 U21 R20 M21 M20 N20 K21 Y16 N21 R21 AA15 Y12
D7 C5 C6 B5 D9 D10 C7 B7 B11 C12 B12 D13 C13 B14 A14 B15 C9 E12 B8 B9 C10 B10 D12 E13 E15 D15 C15 B16 C16 D16 B17 B18 C18 D18 A4 B4 D6 B3 B2 C3 E3 F6 E10 E9 E7 G6 G7 F7 F9
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
95
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
sdrc_ncs0 sdrc_ncs1 sdrc_clk sdrc_nclk sdrc_cke0 sdrc_cke1 sdrc_nras sdrc_ncas sdrc_nwe sdrc_dm 0 sdrc_ dm1 sdrc_ dm2 sdrc_dm 3 sdrc_dqs0 sdrc_dqs1 sdrc_dqs2 sdrc_dqs3
Chip select 0 Chip select 1 Clock Clock Invert Clock Enable 0 Clock Enable 1 SDRAM Row Access SDRAM column address strobe SDRAM write enable Data Mask 0 Data Mask 1 Data Mask 2 Data Mask 3 Data Strobe 0 Data Strobe 1 Data Strobe 2 Data Strobe 3
O O IO O O O O O O O O O O IO IO IO IO
NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
T21 T20 A12 B13 Y15 Y13 V21 U20 Y18 H1 A14 A4 A18 C2 B15 B8 A19
A19 B19 A10 A11 B20 C20 D19 C19 A20 B6 B13 A7 A16 A5 A13 A8 A17
(1) NA in this table stands for "Not Applicable". (2) For a list of pins not supported on a particular package, see Table 2-4.
96
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
2.5.2
Video Interfaces
Table 2-7. Video Interfaces CAM Signals Description
SIGNAL NAME [1] cam_hs cam_vs cam_xclka cam_xclkb cam_d0 cam_d1 cam_d2 cam_d3 cam_d4 cam_d5 cam_d6 cam_d7 cam_d8 cam_d9 cam_d10 cam_d11 cam_fld cam_pclk cam_wen cam_strobe cam_global_reset cam_shutter
DESCRIPTION [2] Camera Horizontal Synchronization Camera Vertical Synchronization Camera Clock Output a Camera Clock Output b Camera digital image data bit 0 Camera digital image data bit 1 Camera digital image data bit 2 Camera digital image data bit 3 Camera digital image data bit 4 Camera digital image data bit 5 Camera digital image data bit 6 Camera digital image data bit 7 Camera digital image data bit 8 Camera digital image data bit 9 Camera digital image data bit 10 Camera digital image data bit 11 Camera field identification Camera pixel clock Camera Write Enable Flash strobe control signal Global reset is used strobe synchronization Mechanical shutter control signal
TYPE [3] IO IO O O I I I I I I I I I I I I IO I I O IO O
BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] A24 A23 C25 B26 AG17 AH17 B24 C24 D24 A25 K28 L28 K27 L27 B25 C26 C23 C27 B23 D25 C23 / AH3 / AA21 B23 / AF3 / T21
BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] C23 D23 C25 E25 AE16 AE15 A24 B24 D24 C24 P25 P26 N25 N26 D25 E26 B23 C26 A23 D26 B23/M3/V17 A23 / T19/ L3
BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4] A22 E18 B22 C22 AB18 AC18 G19 F19 G20 B21 L24 K24 J23 K23 F21 G21 H24 J19 F18 J20 H24/ AA2/ AB20 F18/ Y2/ AA18
NOTE
For more information, see Display Subsystem / Display Subsystem Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
97
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
98
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
99
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
2.5.3
DESCRIPTION [2] Bidirectional HDQ 1-Wire control and data Interface. Output is open drain.
For more information, see Multimaster High-Speed I2C Controller / HS I2C Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-12. Serial Communication Interfaces I2C Signals Description
SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4]
INTER-INTEGRATED CIRCUIT INTERFACE (I2C1) i2c1_scl i2c1_sda I2C Master Serial clock. Output is open drain. I2C Serial Bidirectional Data. Output is open drain. OD IOD K21 J21 J25 J24 K20 K21
INTER-INTEGRATED CIRCUIT INTERFACE (I2C3) i2c3_scl i2c3_sda i2c3_sccbe I2C Master Serial clock. Output is open drain. I2C Serial Bidirectional Data. Output is open drain. Serial Camera Control Bus Enable OD IOD OD AF14 AG14 J25 AB4 AC4 J23 AC13 AC12 A24
INTER-INTEGRATED CIRCUIT INTERFACE (I2C2) i2c2_scl i2c2_sda i2c2_sccbe I2C Master Serial clock. Output is open drain. I2C Serial Bidirectional Data. Output is open drain. Serial Camera Control Bus Enable OD IOD OD AF15 AE15 J25 C2 C1 J23 AC15 AC14 A24
For more information, see Power Reset and Clock Management / PRCM Introduction to Power Management / SmartReflex Voltage-Control Overview section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-13. Serial Communication Interfaces SmartReflex Signals Description(1)
SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4]
INTER-INTEGRATED CIRCUIT INTERFACE (I2C4) i2c4_scl i2c4_sda I2C Master Serial clock. Output is open drain. I2C Serial Bidirectional Data. Output is open drain. OD IOD AD26 AE26 AD15 W16 Y16 Y15
(1) For more information on SmartReflex voltage control, see the PRCM chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
For more information, see Multi-Channel Buffered Serial Port / McBSP Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-14. Serial Communication Interfaces McBSP LP Signals Description
SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4]
100
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
MULTICHANNEL SERIAL (McBSP LP 2) mcbsp2_dr mcbsp2_dx mcbsp2_clkx mcbsp2_fsx Received serial data Transmitted serial data Combined serial clock Combined frame synchronization I O IO IO R21 M21 N21 P21 T18 R19 R18 U18 V19 R20 T21 V20
MULTICHANNEL SERIAL (McBSP LP 3) mcbsp3_dr mcbsp3_dx mcbsp3_clkx mcbsp3_fsx Received serial data Transmitted serial data Combined serial clock Combined frame synchronization I O IO IO AE6 / AB25 / U21 AF6 / AB26 / V21 AF5 / AA25 / W21 AE5 / AD25 / K26 T20 / AA24 / N3 U17 / Y24 / P3 T17 / AD22 / U3 P20 / AD21 / W3 V5 / Y18 V6 / W18 W4 / V18 V4 / AA19
MULTICHANNEL SERIAL (McBSP LP 4) mcbsp4_dr mcbsp4_dx mcbsp4_clkx mcbsp4_fsx Received serial data Transmitted serial data Combined serial clock Combined frame synchronization I O IO IO R8 / AD1 P8 / AD2 T8 / AE1 N8 / AC1 C4 / U4 B5 / R3 B4 / V3 C5 / T3 G5 F3 F4 G4
MULTICHANNEL SERIAL (McBSP LP 5) mcbsp5_dr mcbsp5_dx mcbsp5_clkx mcbsp5_fsx Received serial data Transmitted serial data Combined serial clock Combined frame synchronization I O IO IO AE11 AF13 AF10 AH9 Y3 AE3 AB2 AB1 AC5 AC8 AC1 AD2
For more information, see Multichannel SPI / McSPI Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-15. Serial Communication Interfaces McSPI Signals Description(1)
SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4]
MULTICHANNEL SERIAL PORT INTERFACE (McSPI1) mcspi1_clk mcspi1_simo mcspi1_somi mcspi1_cs0 mcspi1_cs1 mcspi1_cs2 mcspi1_cs3 SPI Clock Slave data in, master data out Slave data out, master data in SPI Enable 0, polarity configured by software SPI Enable 1, polarity configured by software SPI Enable 2, polarity configured by software SPI Enable 3, polarity configured by software IO IO IO IO O O O AB3 AB4 AA4 AC2 AC3 AB1 AB2 P9 P8 P7 R7 R8 R9 T8 T5 R4 T4 T6 NA NA R5
MULTICHANNEL SERIAL PORT INTERFACE (McSPI2) mcspi2_clk mcspi2_simo mcspi2_somi mcspi2_cs0 SPI Clock Slave data in, master data out Slave data out, master data in SPI Enable 0, polarity configured by software IO IO IO IO AA3 Y2 Y3 Y4 W7 W8 U8 V8 N5 N4 N3 M5
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
101
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
MULTICHANNEL SERIAL PORT INTERFACE (McSPI3) mcspi3_clk mcspi3_simo mcspi3_somi mcspi3_cs0 mcspi3_cs1 SPI Clock Slave data in, master data out Slave data out, master data in SPI Enable 0, polarity configured by software SPI Enable 1, polarity configured by software IO IO IO IO O H26 / AE2 / AE13 H25 / AG5 / AF11 E28 / AH5 / AG12 J26 / AF4 / AH12 AC27 / AG4 / AH14 W10 / M24 / AA3 R10 / M26 / AC3 F25 / T10 / AD4 U9 / N24 / AD3 AC25 / U10 / AD2 G24 / Y1 / AD8 H23 / AB5 / AD6 D23 / AB3 / AC6 K22 / V3 / AC7 V21 / W3 / AD9
MULTICHANNEL SERIAL PORT INTERFACE (McSPI4) mcspi4_clk mcspi4_simo mcspi4_somi mcspi4_cs0 SPI Clock Slave data in, master data out Slave data out, master data in SPI Enable 0, polarity configured by software IO IO IO IO Y8 / Y21 V21 U21 K26 U19 / H3 U17 T20 P20 V7 / W19 W18 Y18 AA19
For more information, see UART/IrDA/CIR / UART/IrDA/CIR Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-16. Serial Communication Interfaces UARTs Signals Description
SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4]
UNIVERSAL ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER/TRANSMITTER (UART1) uart1_cts uart1_rts uart1_rx uart1_tx UART1 Clear To Send UART1 Request To Send UART1 Receive data UART1 Transmit data I O I O AG22 / W8 / T21 AH22 / AA9 F28 / Y8 / AE7 E26 / AA8 AE21 / T19 / W2 AE22 / R2 H3 / H25 / AE4 L4 / G26 AC19 / AC2 / AA18 W6 / AB19 E23 / V7 / AC3 D24 / W7
UNIVERSAL ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER/TRANSMITTER (UART2) uart2_cts uart2_rts uart2_rx uart2_tx UART2 Clear To Send UART2 Request To Send UART2 Receive data UART2 Transmit data I O I O AF6 / AB26 / U26 AE6 / AB25 / U27 AE5 / AD25/ U28 AF5 / AA25/ T27 Y24/ P3/ W20 AA24/ N3/ V18 W3/ AD21/ Y20 U3/AD22/V20 V6/ U23 V5/ U24 T23/ V4 T24/ W4
UNIVERSAL ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER/TRANSMITTER (UART3) / IrDA uart3_cts_rctx uart3_rts_sd uart3_rx_irrx uart3_tx_irtx UART3 Clear To Send (input), Remote TX (output) UART3 Request To Send, IR enable UART3 Receive data, IR and Remote RX UART3 Transmit data, IR TX IO O I O H18 / U26 H19 / U27 AG24 / H20 / U28 / F27 AH24 / H21 / T27/ G26 W20 / F23 V18 / F24 AD23 / Y20 / H24/ H26 AD24 / V20 / J29 / G24 A23 / U23 B23 / U24 AD21 / B24 / T23 / E24 AC21 / C23 / T24/ F23
UNIVERSAL ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER/TRANSMITTER (UART4) / IrDA uart4_rx uart4_tx UART4 Receive data UART4 Transmit data I O J8 K8 C6 B3 NA NA
For more information, see High-Speed USB Host Subsystem and High-Speed USB OTG Controller / High-Speed USB Host Subsystem / High-Speed USB Host Subsystem Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-17. Serial Communication Interfaces USB Signals DescriptionSection 4.3.6
SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4]
102
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 2-17. Serial Communication Interfaces USB Signals DescriptionSection 4.3.6 (continued)
SIGNAL NAME [1] hsusb0_clk hsusb0_stp hsusb0_dir hsusb0_nxt hsusb0_data0 hsusb0_data1 hsusb0_data2 hsusb0_data3 hsusb0_data4 hsusb0_data5 hsusb0_data6 hsusb0_data7 MM_FSUSB3 mm3_rxdm mm3_rxdp mm3_rxrcv mm3_txse0 mm3_txdat mm3_txen_n MM_FSUSB2 mm2_rxdm mm2_rxdp mm2_rxrcv mm2_txse0 mm2_txdat mm2_txen_n MM_FSUSB1 mm1_rxdm mm1_rxdp mm1_rxrcv mm1_txse0 mm1_txdat mm1_txen_n HSUSB2 hsusb2_clk hsusb2_stp hsusb2_dir hsusb2_nxt hsusb2_data0 hsusb2_data1 hsusb2_data2 hsusb2_data3 hsusb2_data4 hsusb2_data5 hsusb2_data6 Dedicated for external transceiver 60-MHz clock input to PHY Dedicated for external transceiver Stop signal Dedicated for external transceiver Data direction control from PHY Dedicated for external transceiver Next signal from PHY Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation O O I I IO IO IO IO IO IO IO AE7 AF7 AG7 AH7 AG8 AH8 AB2 V3 Y2 Y3 Y4 AE4 AF6 AE6 AF7 AF9 AE9 T8 V9 W8 U8 V8 AC3 AC9 AC10 AD11 AC11 AD12 R5 M4 N4 N3 M5 Vminus receive data (not used in 3- or 4-pin configurations) Vplus receive data (not used in 3- or 4-pin configurations) Differential receiver signal input (not used in 3-pin mode) Single-ended zero. Used as VM in 4-pin VP_VM mode. USB data. Used as VP in 4-pin VP_VM mode. Transmit enable IO IO IO IO IO IO AG9 AF10 AF11 AG12 AH12 AH14 V2 AB2 AC3 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD5 AC1 AD6 AC6 AC7 AD9 Vminus receive data (not used in 3- or 4-pin configurations) Vplus receive data (not used in 3- or 4-pin configurations) Differential receiver signal input (not used in 3-pin mode) Single-ended zero. Used as VM in 4-pin VP_VM mode. USB data. Used as VP in 4-pin VP_VM mode. Transmit enable IO IO IO IO IO IO AH7 AF7 AG8 AH8 AB2 V3 AF7 AF6 AF9 AE9 T8 V9 AD11 AC9 AC11 AD12 R5 M4 Vminus receive data (not used in 3- or 4-pin configurations) Vplus receive data (not used in 3- or 4-pin configurations) Differential receiver signal input (not used in 3-pin mode) Single-ended zero. Used as VM in 4-pin VP_VM mode. USB data. Used as VP in 4-pin VP_VM mode. Transmit enable IO IO IO IO IO IO AE3 AH3 AD1 AE1 AD2 AC1 K3 M3 U4 V3 R3 T3 NA NA NA NA NA NA DESCRIPTION [2] Dedicated for external transceiver 60-MHz clock input to PHY Dedicated for external transceiver Stop signal Dedicated for external transceiver Data direction control from PHY Dedicated for external transceiver Next signal from PHY Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation TYPE [3] I O I I IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] T28 T25 R28 T26 T27 U28 U27 U26 U25 V28 V27 V26 BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] W19 U20 V19 W18 V20 Y20 V18 W20 W17 Y18 Y19 Y17 BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4] R21 R23 P23 R22 T24 T23 U24 U23 W24 V23 W23 T22
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
103
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 2-17. Serial Communication Interfaces USB Signals DescriptionSection 4.3.6 (continued)
SIGNAL NAME [1] hsusb2_data7 HSUSB1 hsusb1_clk hsusb1_stp hsusb1_dir hsusb1_nxt hsusb1_data0 hsusb1_data1 hsusb1_data2 hsusb1_data3 hsusb1_data4 hsusb1_data5 hsusb1_data6 hsusb1_data7 Dedicated for external transceiver 60-MHz clock input to PHY Dedicated for external transceiver Stop signal Dedicated for external transceiver data direction control from PHY Dedicated for external transceiver Next signal from PHY Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation O O I I IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO AE10 AF10 AF9 AG9 AF11 AG12 AH12 AH14 AE11 AH9 AF13 AE13 AB3 AB2 AA4 V2 AC3 AD4 AD3 AD2 Y3 AB1 AE3 AA3 AD3 AC1 AC4 AD5 AD6 AC6 AC7 AD9 AC5 AD2 AC8 AD8 DESCRIPTION [2] Dedicated for external transceiver Bidirectional data bus additional signals for 12-pin ULPI operation TYPE [3] IO BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] AA3 BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] W7 BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4] N5
NA in this table stands for "Not applicable". This pin is not supported on the CUS package.
104
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
2.5.4
DESCRIPTION [2]
TYPE [3]
MULTIMEDIA MEMORY CARD (MMC1) / SECURE DIGITAL IO (SDIO1) mmc1_clk mmc1_cmd mmc1_dat0 mmc1_dat1 mmc1_dat2 mmc1_dat3 MMC/SD Output Clock MMC/SD command signal MMC/SD Card Data bit 0 / SPI Serial Input MMC/SD Card Data bit 1 MMC/SD Card Data bit 2 MMC/SD Card Data bit 3 O IO IO IO IO IO N28 M27 N27 N26 N25 P28 N19 L18 M19 M18 K18 N20 M23 L23 M22 M21 M20 N23
MULTIMEDIA MEMORY CARD (MMC2) / SECURE DIGITAL IO (SDIO2) mmc2_clk mmc2_dir_dat0 mmc2_dir_dat1 mmc2_dir_dat2 mmc2_dir_dat3 mmc2_clkin mmc2_dat0 mmc2_dat1 mmc2_dat2 mmc2_dat3 mmc2_dat4 mmc2_dat5 mmc2_dat6 mmc2_dat7 mmc2_dir_cmd mmc2_cmd MMC/SD Output Clock Direction control for DAT0 signal case an external transceiver used Direction control for DAT1 and DAT3 signals case an external transceiver used Direction control for DAT2 signal case an external transceiver used Direction control for DAT4, DAT5, DAT6, and DAT7 signals case an external transceiver used MMC/SD input Clock MMC/SD Card Data bit 0 MMC/SD Card Data bit 1 MMC/SD Card Data bit 2 MMC/SD Card Data bit 3 MMC/SD Card Data bit 4 MMC/SD Card Data bit 5 MMC/SD Card Data bit 6 MMC/SD Card Data bit 7 Direction control for CMD signal case an external transceiver is used MMC/SD command signal O O O O O I IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO O IO AE2 AE4 AH3 AF19 AE21 AE3 AH5 AH4 AG4 AF4 AE4 / AB3 AH3 / AB4 AF3 / AA4 AE3 / AC2 AF3 AG5 W10 V10 M3 E4 G3 K3 T10 T9 U10 U9 P9 / V10 M3/P8 L3/P7 K3/R7 L3 R10 Y1 AB2 AA2 AC17 AB16 AA1 AB3 Y3 W3 V3 AB2 / T5 AA2 / R4 Y2 / T4 AA1 / T6 Y2 AB5
MULTIMEDIA MEMORY CARD (MMC3) / SECURE DIGITAL IO (SDIO3) mmc3_clk mmc3_cmd mmc3_dat0 mmc3_dat1 mmc3_dat2 mmc3_dat3 mmc3_dat4 mmc3_dat5 mmc3_dat6 mmc3_dat7 MMC/SD Output Clock MMC/SD command signal MMC/SD Card Data bit 0 / SPI Serial Input MMC/SD Card Data bit 1 MMC/SD Card Data bit 2 MMC/SD Card Data bit 3 MMC/SD Card Data bit 4 MMC/SD Card Data bit 5 MMC/SD Card Data bit 6 MMC/SD Card Data bit 7 O IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO AB1 / AF10 AC3 / AE10 AE4 / AE11 AH3 / AH9 AF3 / AF13 AE3 / AE13 AF11 AG9 AF9 AH14 R9 / AB2 R8 / AB3 V10 / Y3 M3/AB1 L3/AE3 K3/AA3 AC3 V2 AA4 AD2 AC1 AD3 AB2 / AC5 AA2 / AD2 Y2 / AC8 AA1 / AD8 AD6 AD5 AC4 AD9
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
105
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
2.5.5
Test Interfaces
Table 2-19. Test Interfaces ETK Signals Description
SIGNAL NAME [1] etk_ctl etk_clk etk_d0 etk_d1 etk_d2 etk_d3 etk_d4 etk_d5 etk_d6 etk_d7 etk_d8 etk_d9 etk_d10 etk_d11 etk_d12 etk_d13 etk_d14 etk_d15
DESCRIPTION [2] ETK trace ctl ETK trace clock ETK data 0 ETK data 1 ETK data 2 ETK data 3 ETK data 4 ETK data 5 ETK data 6 ETK data 7 ETK data 8 ETK data 9 ETK data 10 ETK data 11 ETK data 12 ETK data 13 ETK data 14 ETK data 15
TYPE [3] O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O
BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] AE10 AF10 AF11 AG12 AH12 AE13 AE11 AH9 AF13 AH14 AF9 AG9 AE7 AF7 AG7 AH7 AG8 AH8
BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] AB3 AB2 AC3 AD4 AD3 AA3 Y3 AB1 AE3 AD2 AA4 V2 AE4 AF6 AE6 AF7 AF9 AE9
BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4] AD3 AC1 AD6 AC6 AC7 AD8 AC5 AD2 AC8 AD9 AC4 AD5 AC3 AC9 AC10 AD11 AC11 AD12
106
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Serial clock dual edge Serial data out (System Trace messages) Serial data out (System Trace messages) Serial data out (System Trace messages) Serial data out (System Trace messages)
O O O O O
2.5.6
Miscellaneous
For more information, see Timers / GP Timers / GP Timers Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-23. Miscellaneous GP Timer Signals Description
DESCRIPTION [2] PWM or event for GP timer 8 PWM or event for GP timer 9 PWM or event for GP timer 10 PWM or event for GP timer 11
TYPE [3] IO IO IO IO
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
107
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
2.5.7
General-Purpose IOs
For more information, see General-Purpose Interface / General-Purpose Interface Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-24. General-Purpose IOs Signals Description(1)
SIGNAL NAME [1] gpio_0 gpio_1 gpio_2 gpio_3 gpio_4 gpio_5 gpio_6 gpio_7 gpio_8 gpio_9 gpio_10 gpio_11 gpio_12 gpio_13 gpio_14 gpio_15 gpio_16 gpio_17 gpio_18 gpio_19 gpio_20 gpio_21 gpio_22 gpio_23 gpio_24 gpio_25 gpio_26 gpio_27 gpio_28 gpio_29 gpio_30 gpio_31 gpio_34 gpio_35 gpio_36 gpio_37 gpio_38 gpio_39 gpio_40 gpio_41 gpio_42 gpio_43 gpio_44 gpio_45 gpio_46 gpio_47
DESCRIPTION [2] General-purpose IO 0 General-purpose IO 1 General-purpose IO 2 General-purpose IO 3 General-purpose IO 4 General-purpose IO 5 General-purpose IO 6 General-purpose IO 7 General-purpose IO 8 General-purpose IO 9 General-purpose IO 10 General-purpose IO 11 General-purpose IO 12 General-purpose IO 13 General-purpose IO 14 General-purpose IO 15 General-purpose IO 16 General-purpose IO 17 General-purpose IO 18 General-purpose IO 19 General-purpose IO 20 General-purpose IO 21 General-purpose IO 22 General-purpose IO 23 General-purpose IO 24 General-purpose IO 25 General-purpose IO 26 General-purpose IO 27 General-purpose IO 28 General-purpose IO 29 General-purpose IO 30 General-purpose IO 31 General-purpose IO 34 General-purpose IO 35 General-purpose IO 36 General-purpose IO 37 General-purpose IO 38 General-purpose IO 39 General-purpose IO 40 General-purpose IO 41 General-purpose IO 42 General-purpose IO 43 General-purpose IO 44 General-purpose IO 45 General-purpose IO 46 General-purpose IO 47
TYPE [3] IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO IO
BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] AF26 AF25 AH26 AG26 AE14 AF18 AF19 AE21 AF21 AF22 AG25 AA11 AF10 AE10 AF11 AG12 AH12 AE13 AE11 AH9 AF13 AH14 AF9 AG9 AE7 AF7 AG7 AH7 AG8 AH8 AF24 AA10 N4 M4 L4 K4 T3 R3 N3 M3 L3 K3 H2 K2 P1 R1
BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] V16 W15 F3 D3 C3 E3 E4 G3 D4 V12 AE14 Y15 AB2 AB3 AC3 AD4 AD3 AA3 Y3 AB1 AE3 AD2 AA4 V2 AE4 AF6 AE6 AF7 AF9 AE9 AD7 Y14 J2 H1 H2 G2 F1 F2 E1 E2 D1 D2 V1 Y1 T1 U2
BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4] W16 Y13 AB12 AC16 AD17 AD18 AC17 AB16 AA15 AD23 Y7 AC24 AC1 AD3 AD6 AC6 AC7 AD8 AC5 AD2 AC8 AD9 AC4 AD5 AC3 AC9 AC10 AD11 AC11 AD12 Y10 AD24 K4 K3 K2 J4 J3 J2 J1 H1 H2 G2 R2 T2 U1 R3
108
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
109
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] AE16 AE15 A24 B24 D24 C24 P25 P26 N25 N26 D25 E26 E25 AD17 AD16 AE18 AE17 U18 R18 T18 R19 W19 / N19(3) U20 / L18(3) V19 / M19 M18
(3) (3)
BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) [4] AB18 AC18 G19 F19 G20 B21 L24 K24 J23 K23 F21 G21 C22 NA NA NA NA V20 T21 V19 R20 M23(3) / R21 L23(3) / R23 M22(3) / P23 M21(3) M20(3)/R22 N23(3)/T24 J20 / N22(3) NA NA P24(3) Y1 / T23 AB5 / U24 AB3 Y3 W3 V3 AB2 AA2 Y2 AA1 V6 V5 W4 V4 NA NA NA NA W7 W6
/ R28
(3)
N26
N25(3) / T26 P28(3) / T27 D25 / P27(3) P26(3) R27 R25(3) AE2 / U28 AG5 / U27 AH5 AH4 AG4 AF4 AE4 AH3 AF3 AE3 AF6 AE6 AF5 AE5 AB26 AB25 AA25 AD25 AA8 AA9
W18 / K18(3) V20 / N20(3) M20(3) / D26 P17(3) P18 P19(3) Y20 / W10 V18 / R10 T10 T9 U10 U9 V10 M3 L3 K3 P3 N3 U3 W3 Y24 AA24 AD22 AD21 L4 R2
110
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) NA in table stands for "Not Applicable". (2) The subsystem pin multiplexing options are not described in Table 2-1 and Table 2-4. (3) The usage of this GPIO is strongly restricted. For more information, see the General-Purpose Interface / General-Purpose Interface Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
111
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
2.5.8
Power Supplies
Note: For more information, see Power Reset and Clock Management / PRCM Environment and the Power, Reset, and Clock Management / PRCM Functional Description / PRCM Voltage Management Functional Description sections of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). Table 2-25. Power Supplies Signals Description(1)
BALL BOTTOM (CBP Pkg.) [4] Y9 / W9 / T9 / R9 / M9 / L9 / J9 / Y10 / U10 / T10 / R10 / N10 / M10 / L10 / J10 / Y11 / W11 / K11 / J11 / W12 / K13 / Y14 / K14 / J14 / Y15 / W15 / J15 AC4 / J4 / H4 / D8 / AE9 / D9 / D15 / Y16 / AE18 / Y18 / W18 / K18 / J18 / AE19 / Y19 / U19 / T19 / N19 / M19 / J19 / Y20 / W20 / V20 / U20 / P20 / N20 / K20 / J20 / D22 / D23 / AE24 / M25 / L25 / E25 AA15
BALL BOTTOM (CBC Pkg.) [4] H7/ N7/ U7/ V7/ N8/ G9/ L9/ M9/ W9/ Y9/ M10/ P10/ K11/ U11/ V11/ Y11/ G12/ D13/ U13
BALL BOTTOM (CUS Pkg.) (2) [4] W13/ W12/ V13/ V12/ U13/ U12/ T8/ T7/ R8/ R7/ R6/ N8/ N7/ N6/ M12/ M8/ M7/ M6/ L12/ L11/ J10/ J9/ H10/ H9/ G10/ G9/F10
vdd_core
NA
M7/ T7/ Y8/ G11/ Y12/ D15/ M17/ G18/ H20/ R20/ AC21
NA
T20/ T19/ T18/ T17/ R19/ R18/ R17/ M15/ M14/ L15/ L14/ K19/ K18/ K17/ J18/ J17/ H13/ H12/ G13/ G12/ F13/ F12
cap_vddu_wkup_ logic
Decoupling capacitor for WKUP/EMU domains (logic) Input power for the analog part of the MPU, CORE DPLLs, IVA, and the DLL Video DAC power plane Video DAC ground plane 1.8-V power for standard IOs
NA
K14
NA
Y12
vdda_dplls_dll
K15
NA
K13
NA
G18
V25 Y26 AD3 / AD4 / W4 / AF8 / AE8 / AF16 / AE16 / AF23 / AE23 / F25 / F26 / AG27 U1 / J1 / F1 / J2 / F2 / R4 / B5 / A5 / AH6 / B8 / A8 / B12 / A12 / D16 / C16 / B18 / A18 / B22 / A22 / G28 / C28 AA16
NA NA NA
V25 V24 G4/ M4/ T4/ Y4/ L7/ AC7/ D9/ AE10/ C11/ J15/ AC15/ A18/ J18/ AC18/ AD20/ E24/ L24/ T24/ W24/ AC24 / AB24 NA
AB13 AB15 Y9 / W10 / W9 / V10 / V9 / U10 / N19 / N18 / N17 / M19 / M18 / M17
vdds_mem
NA
vdda_dpll_per
Input power for the analog part of the Peripheral DPLLs For wakeup LDO and VDDA (2 LDOs SRAM and BG)
NA
U14
NA
U17
vdda_wkup_bg_bb
AA14
NA
W14
NA
AA13
112
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
AG2 / U2 / B2 / H2 / B18 / AB5 / AG3 / W3 / P3 / AB14 / AB20 / P2 / J3 / E3 / A3 / P4 F22 / E2 / C22 / B4 / / E4 / AG6 / D7 / B7 / B10 / B15 C7 / V9 / U9 / P9 / N9 / K9 / W10 / V10 / P10 / K10 / D10 / C10 / AF12 / AE12 / Y12 / K12 / J12 / Y13 / W13 / J13 / D13 / C13 / W14 / K16 / J16 / W17 / K17 / J17 / W19 / V19 / R19 / P19 / L19 / K19 / D19 / C19 / AF20 / AE20 / T20 / R20 / M20 / L20 / D21 / C22 / AC25 / Y25 / W25 / AC26 / R26 / L26 / A26 / G27 / B27 W16 K25 NA NA
vdds_sram vdds_mmc1
SRAM LDOs Input power for MMC1 dual voltage buffers Power supply for dual voltage GPIOs Ground IO power plane Ground IO power plane
U12 N23
NA NA
AA12 N24
NA NA NA NA NA NA
NA NA NA NA NA NA
H8 NA NA NA NA U8
cap_vdd_sram_mpu_i Decoupling va capacitor for SRAM in processor domains cap_vdd_sram_core Decoupling capacitor for CORE domain (SRAM) IO power plane Decoupling capacitor for WKUP/EMU domains (array) Ground Decoupling capacitor for processor domains (bb) Kelvin ground
L21
NA
K20
NA
H17
vdds cap_vddu_array
AG21 AH20
NA NA
AD19 AE19
NA NA
NA N20
vss cap_vdd_bb_mpu_iva
AH21 U4
NA NA
AC19 D6
NA NA
NA N21
sys_xtalgnd
Y17
NA
AF23
NA
W15
(1) NA in this table stands for "Not applicable". (2) For a list of pins not supported on a particular package, see Table 2-4.
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
113
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
2.5.9
DESCRIPTION [2]
TYPE [3]
32-kHz clock input Main input clock. Oscillator input or LVCMOS at 19.2, 13, or 12 MHz. Output of oscillator Alternate clock source selectable for GPTIMERs (maximum 54 MHz), USB (48 MHz), or NTSC/PAL (54 MHz) Request from device for system clock (open source type) Configurable output clock1 Configurable output clock2 Boot configuration mode bit 0 Boot configuration mode bit 1 Boot configuration mode bit 2 Boot configuration mode bit 3 Boot configuration mode bit 4 Boot configuration mode bit 5 Boot configuration mode bit 6 Power On Reset Warm Boot Reset (open drain output) External FIQ input Indicates the voltage mode Indicates the voltage mode Indicates the voltage mode External A request 0 (system expansion). Level (active low) or edge (falling) selectable. External A request 1 (system expansion). Level (active low) or edge (falling) selectable. External A request 2 (system expansion). Level (active low) or edge (falling) selectable. External A request 3 (system expansion). Level (active low) or edge (falling) selectable.
I AI-I AO I
sys_clkreq sys_clkout1 sys_clkout2 sys_boot0 sys_boot1 sys_boot2 sys_boot3 sys_boot4 sys_boot5 sys_boot6 sys_nrespwron sys_nreswarm sys_nirq sys_nvmode1 sys_nvmode2 sys_off_mode sys_ndmareq0 sys_ndmareq1 sys_ndmareq2 sys_ndmareq3
IO O O I I I I I I I I IOD I O O O I I I I
AF25 AG25 AE22 AH26 AG26 AE14 AF18 AF19 AE21 AF21 AH25 AF24 AF26 AD26 AE26 AF22 U8 T8 / J8 L3 / R8 K3 / P8
NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA AA5 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA
Y13 Y7 AA6 AB12 AC16 AD17 AD18 AC17 AB16 AA15 AA10 Y10 W16 Y16 Y15 AD23 D2 F4 / C2 H2 / G5 G2 / F3
(1) NA in this table stands for "Not applicable". (2) For a list of pins not supported on a particular package, see Table 2-4.
114
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) For more details on the feedthrough pin connections, please refer to the PoP memory datasheet.
BALL TOP A12 AA23 H23 K1 Y23 AA1 AC8 AC13 L1 U1 AC11 AB9 AC9 A1 A2 A22 A23 AB1 AB23 AC1 AC2 AC22 AC23
BALL BOTTOM A15 AE28 AF28 J28 M1 AA1 AF1 AH10 AH15 N1 AH13 AG11 AH11 A1 A2 A27 A28 AG1 AG28 AH1 AH2 AH27 AH28
FEED-THROUGH BALL NAME pop_a12_a15 pop_aa23_ae28 pop_h23_af28 pop_k1_j28 pop_y23_m1 pop_aa1_aa1 pop_ac8_af1 pop_ac13_ah10 pop_l1_ah15 pop_u1_n1 pop_ac11_ah13 pop_ab9_ag11 pop_ac9_ah11 NC NC pop_a22_a27 pop_a23_a28 pop_ab1_ag1 pop_ab23_ag28 pop_ac1_ah1 pop_ac2_ah2 pop_ac22_ah27 pop_ac23_ah28
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
115
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) For more details on the feedthrough pin connections, please refer to the PoP memory datasheet.
116
TERMINAL DESCRIPTION Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
3 Electrical Characteristics
NOTE
For more information, see the Power Reset and Clock Management / PRCM Environment section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
3.1
vdd_mpu_iva vdd_core vdda_wkup_bg_bb vdda_dplls_dll vdda_dpll_per vdds_sram vdda_dac vdds vdds_mem vdds_mmc1 vdds_x VESD
Supply voltage range for MPU / IVA domain Supply voltage range for core domain Supply voltage range for wake-up domain (internal LDO) Supply voltage for MPU, IVA, Core DPLLs, and DLL Supply voltage for DPLLs (peripherals) Supply voltage for SRAM LDOs Supply voltage for video buffers and DAC Supply voltage for 1.8-V I/O macros Supply voltage for memory buffers Supply voltage range for mmc1 dual voltage IOs Supply voltage range for dual voltage GPIOs JTAG(9) ESD stress voltage(1) HBM (Human Body Model)(2) CAM(6) GPMC(8) Other signals CDM (Charged Device Model)(3)
Current-pulse injection on each IO pin(5) Clamp current for an input or output Storage temperature range
(1) Electrostatic discharge (ESD) to measure device sensitivity/immunity to damage caused by electrostatic discharges into the device. (2) Level listed above is the passing level per ANSI/ESDA/JEDEC JS-001-2010. JEDEC document JEP155 states that 500V HBM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process, and manufacturing with less than 500V HBM is possible if necessary precautions are taken. Pins listed as 1000V may actually have higher performance. (3) Level listed above is the passing level per EIA-JEDEC JESD22-C101E. JEDEC document JEP157 states that 250V CDM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process. Pins listed as 250V may actually have higher performance. (4) For tape and reel the storage temperature range is [10C; +50C] with a maximum relative humidity of 70%. It is recommended returning to ambient room temperature before usage. (5) Each device is tested with an IO pin injection of 200 mA with a stress voltage of 1.5 times the maximum Vdd at room temperature. (6) Corresponding signals: cam_d0, cam_d1, cam_d6, cam_d7, cam_d8, cam_d9. Refer to Multiplexing Characteristicsto determine the ball information per package. (7) Corresponding signals: dss_data0, dss_data1, dss_data2, dss_data3, dss_data4, dss_data5. Refer to Multiplexing Characteristics to determine the ball information per package. (8) Corresponding signals: All 46 GPMC interface signals (vdds_mem is not included to this exception list). Refer to Multiplexing Characteristics to determine the ball information per package. (9) Corresponding signals: All 8 JTAG interface signals (jtag_emu0, jtag_emu1, jtag_ntrst, jtag_rtck, jtag_tck, jtag_tdi, jtag_tdo, jtag_tms_tmsc). Refer to Multiplexing Characteristics to determine the ball information per package.
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
117
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 3-2 summarizes the power consumption at the ball level. Table 3-2. Maximum Current Ratings at Ball Level
PARAMETER SIGNAL vdd_mpu_iva(7) Maximum current rating for MPU / IVA domain DESCRIPTION Processors DM3730/DM3725 (1G Hz) DM3730/DM3725 (800M Hz) DM3730/DM3725 (600M Hz) vdd_core(1) vdds vdds_mem vdds_mmc1(2) vdds_x Maximum current rating for core domain Core DM3730 DM3725 1400(1)(4) 1200(5) 800(5) 300 230 60 35 20 2 5 60 30 10 41 mA mA mA mA mA mA mA mA mA mA mA
(3)
MAX
UNIT
Maximum current rating for 1.8-V I/O macros Maximum current rating for memory buffers Maximum current rating for mmc1 dual voltage buffers Maximum current rating for GPIO dual voltage buffers
vdda_wkup_bg_b Maximum current rating for wake-up, bandgap and VBB LDOs b vdda_dac vdda_dplls_dll vdda_dpll_per vdds_sram Maximum current rating for video buffers and DAC Maximum current rating for MPU, IVA, core DPLLs and DLL Maximum current rating for DPLLs (peripherals) Maximum current rating for SRAM LDOs (common)
(1) With SmartReflexTM enabled. (2) MMC card and I/O card are not included. (3) The maximum current ratings documented in this table are preliminary data which are subject to change. (4) Conditions used for maximum current ratings are worst case: TJ is up to 90C Cold process is used VDD1 (vdd_mpu_iva) supplies 1.38 V (maximum voltage supported) In these conditions, the current listed as 1400mV is the addition of the: Current when running Dhrystone on ARM@1GHz multiplied by a factor x1.5 (to take care of NEON activity) Current when running H.264 on IVA@800MHz with a x1.1 factor (to take care of more aggressive SW than H.264) (5) Conditions used for maximum current ratings are worst case: TJ is up to 90C Hot process is used VDD1 (vdd_mpu_iva) nominal OPP voltage: DM3730 (800M Hz): @1.27V DM3730 (600M Hz): @1.14V (6) This maximum vdd_mpu_iva current is observed at OPP1G operating point. (7) Depending on the microprocessor chosen, the IVA feature may or may not be supported. See the Features section for more information on device features.
118
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
3.2
(1) If device is only operated at OPP1G, then POH can be extended to 35K POH.
NOTE
Logic functions and parameter values are not assured out of the range specified in the recommended operating conditions.
1.80 50 1.80 30
1.91 1.91
V mVPP V mVPP
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
119
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks. OPP voltage values may change following the silicon characterization result.
120
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
3.3
DC Electrical Characteristics
Table 3-5 summarizes the dc electrical characteristics. Note: The interfaces or signals described in Table 3-5 correspond to the interfaces or signals available in multiplexing mode 0. All interfaces or signals multiplexed on the balls / pins described in Table 3-5 have the same DC electrical characteristics. Table 3-5. DC Electrical Characteristics
PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT
SDRC Mode (CBP Balls H15 / A16 / A17)(4) VIH VIL VHYS VOH VOL CIN tTIN(2) tROUT(2) tFOUT(2) COUT
(1)
(19)
: C14 / B14 / C15 / B16 / D17 / C17 / B17 / D18 / H9 / H10 / H11 / H12 / A13 / A14 / H16 / H17 / H14 / H13 / 0.7 * vdds_mem 0.3 * vdds_mem 0.07 IOH = 4 mA IOL = 4 mA 0.8 * vdds_mem 0 vdds_mem 0.2 * vdds_mem 1.15 10 1.15 1.10 2 4 4 12 V V V V V pF ns ns ns pF
High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage Hysteresis voltage at an input High-level output voltage, driver enabled, pullup or pulldown disabled Low-level output voltage, driver enabled, pullup or pulldown disabled Input capacitance Input recommended rise, tRIN, and fall time, tFIN (measured between 20% and 80% at PAD) Output maximum rise time (rise time, tROUT, evaluated between 20% and 80% at PAD) @ maximum load Output maximum fall time (fall time, tFOUT, evaluated between 20% and 80% at PAD) @ maximum load Load capacitance DS0 = 0(3) DS0 = 1(3)
MMC Interface 1 Mode (CBP Balls(19): N28 / M27 / N27 / N26 / N25 / P28) 1.8-V Mode VIH VIL VOH VOL VHYS (1) tTIN (2) High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage High-level output voltage with 100-A sink current IOH Low-level output voltage with 100-A sink current at vdds_mmc1 minimum Hysteresis voltage at an input Input transition time (tRIN or tFIN evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Normal Mode (SPEEDCTRL = 1)(4) High-Speed (SPEEDCTRL = 0)(4) COUT LOUT VIH VIL VOH VOL VHYS (1) Load capacitance Line inductance (except vdds_mmc1) High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage High-level output voltage with 100-A sink current IOH Low-level output voltage with 100-A source current at vdds_mmc1 minimum Hysteresis voltage at an input 0.05 0.625 * vdds_mmc1 0.3 0.75 * vdds_mmc1 0.125 * vdds_mmc1 10 0.1 3 0.70 * vdds_mmc1 0.3 vdds_mmc1 0.2 0.2 vdds_mmc1 + 0.3 0.30 * vdds_mmc1 V V V V V ns
pF nH V V V V V
3.0-V Mode
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
121
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
30 16
pF nH
GPIO Mode (CBP Balls(19): P27 / P26 / R25) 1.8-V Mode VIH VIL VOH VOL VHYS (1) tTIN (2) High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage High-level output voltage with 20-A sink current IOH Low-level output voltage with 1-mA source current at vdds_x minimum Hysteresis voltage at an input Input transition time (tRIN or tFIN evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Input capacitance Load capacitance Line inductance (except vdds_x) High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage High-level output voltage with 20-A sink current IOH Low-level output voltage with 1-mA source current at vdds_sim minimum Hysteresis voltage at an input Input transition time (tRIN or tFIN evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Input capacitance Load capacitance Line inductance (except vdds_x) Normal Mode (SPEEDCTRL = 1)(4)
(2)
0.70 * vdds_x 0.3 0.8 * vdds_x 0.3 0.1 Normal Mode (SPEEDCTRL = 1)(4)
V V V V V
35
ns
CIN COUT LOUT VIH VIL VOH VOL VHYS (1) tTIN
2.5 30 16 0.70 * vdds_x 0.3 0.7 * vdds_x 0.3 0.05 35 vdds_x + 0.3 0.20 * vdds_x vdds_x + 0.3 0.4
pF pF nH V V V V V ns
3.0-V Mode
2.5 30 16
pF pF nH
I2C Mode (CBP Balls(19): K21 / J21 / AF15 / AE15 / AF14 / AG14 / AD26 / AE26) (6) Standard Mode VIH VIL VHYS VOL II CI tFOUT(5) tROUT(5) Fast Mode VIH VIL High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage 0.7 * vdds 0.5 vdds + 0.5 0.3 * vdds V V
(1)
High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage Hysteresis voltage at an input Low-level output voltage open-drain at 3-mA sink current Input current at each I/O pin with an input voltage between 0.1 * vdds to 0.9 * vdds Capacitance for each I/O pin Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 10 pF to 400 pF Output rise time with a capacitive load from 10 pF to 150 pF with internal pullup
V V V V A pF ns ns
20 + 0.1CB
250
122
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
High-Speed Mode VIH VIL VHYS (1) VOL II CI 0.7 * vdds 0.5 0.15 0 10 0.2 * vdds 10 10 40 80 40 vdds + 0.5 0.3 * vdds V V V V A pF ns ns ns
tFOUT(5)(6) Output fall time with a capacitive load from 10 pF to 100 pF at 3-mA sink current Output fall time with a capacitive load of 400 pF at 3-mA sink current tROUT(5) Output rise time with a capacitive load from 10 pF to 80 pF with internal pullup High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage High-level output voltage at 4-mA sink current Low-level output voltage at 4-mA sink current Input capacitance Input transition time (tRIN or tFIN evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Output transition time at 40-pF load (tROUT or tFOUT evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD)
Standard LVCMOS Mode VIH VIL VOH VOL CIN tTIN (2) tTOUT 0.7 * vdds 0.5 vdds 0.45 0.45 1.15 10 10 vdds 0.3 * vdds V V V V pF ns ns
MIPI D-PHY Interface MIPI D-PHY Interface - GPI Mode (CBP Balls(19): AG19 / AH19 / AG18 / AH18 / K28 / L28 / K27 / AG17 / AH17) VIH(7) VIL(8) VHYS (1) CIN tTIN (2) High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage Hysteresis voltage at an input Input capacitance Input transition time (tRIN or tFIN evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) 0.65 * vdds_x(14) 0.3 0.15 1.3 10 vdds_x + 0.3(14) 0.35 * vdds_x(14) V V V pF ns
Other Balls Common to "Other Balls" VIH VIL VHYS (1) VOH VOL High-level input voltage Low-level input voltage Hysteresis voltage at an input High-level output voltage, driver enabled, pullup or pulldown disabled Low-level output voltage, driver enabled, pullup or pulldown disabled IOH = X mA
(17)
V V V V
IOL = X(17) mA
0.45
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
123
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
MIN
NOM
MAX
UNIT
1.00
1.15
1.35 10
pF ns
JTAG interface (CBP Balls(19): AA17 / AA13 / AA12 / AA18 / AA20 / AA19 / AA11 / AA10) CIN tTIN 2.20 10 pF ns Input transition time (rise time, tRIN or fall time, tFIN evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Input capacitance
(2)
Otherwise CIN tTIN 1.15 10 pF ns Input transition time (rise time, tRIN or fall time, tFIN evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD)
Output Capacitance Load and Output Transition Time sys_32k, sys_clkreq, sys_off_mode, sys_clkout1, sys_nirq, uart3_cts_rctx, uart3_rts_sd, uart3_rx_irrx, uart3_tx_irtx, hdq_sio (CBP Balls(19): R27 / AE25 / AF25 / AF22 / AG25 / AF26 / H18 / H19 / H20 / H21 / J25) tTOUT Output transition time (rise time, tROUT or DS[1:0] = 00(3) fall time, tFOUT evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Output load Output transition time (rise time, tROUT or DS[1:0] = 10(3) fall time, tFOUT evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Output load Output transition time (rise time, tROUT or DS[1:0] = 01(3) fall time, tFOUT evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Output load Output transition time (rise time, tROUT or fall time, tFOUT evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Output load Output transition time (rise time, tROUT or fall time, tFOUT evaluated between 10% and 90% at PAD) Output load 1(15) 15(16) ns
CTOUT tTOUT
4 0.4(15)
60 5(16)
pF ns
CTOUT tTOUT
2 0.6(15)
21 7(16)
pF ns
7 1.5 2 0.6 2
33 5 22 2.4(17) 22
pF ns pF ns pF
CAM, HSUSB0, MMC2, UART1, UART2, McBSP, McSPI, ETK Interfaces, sys_clkout2 (CBP Ball(19): AE22)
Hysteresis sys_xtalin pin (CBP Ball(19): AE17) VHYS (1) VHYS (1) Otherwise VHYS(1) Hysteresis voltage at an input 0.15 V (1) Vhys is the magnitude of the difference between the positive-going threshold voltage VT+ and the negative-going threshold voltage VT. Some receivers, but not all, are designed for hysteresis. Vhys applies only to those that are. (2) The tIN (tRIN and tFIN also) value is the recommended condition. The tIN (tRIN and tFIN also) mismatch causes additional delay time inside the device then leads to ac timing invalidation in this DM. The tIN (tRIN and tFIN also) mismatch does not necessarily mean functional failure. This global value may be overridden on a per interface basis if another value is explicitly defined for that interface in the Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics chapter of the data manual. (3) For a full description of the DS0 load compensation register configuration, see the description of the CONTROL_PROG_IO1 configuration registers in System Control Module / Programming Model / Feature Settings / SDRC I/O Drive Strength Selection section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). 124 Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
0.25 0.07
V V
: T28)
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(4) For a full description of the SPEEDCTRL speed register configuration, see the description of the CONTROL_PROG_IO1 configuration registers in System Control Module / Programming Model / Feature Settings section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (5) Rise and fall times are specified for (0.3 * vdds) to (0.7 * vdds). (6) For capacitive load from 100 pF to 400 pF, fall time should be linearly interpolated: tFmin = (1 + (Load 100 pF) / 300 pF) * 10 ns tFmax = (1 + (Load 100 pF) / 300 pF) * 40 ns (7) VIH is the voltage at which the receiver is required to detect a high state in the input signal. (8) VIL is the voltage at which the receiver is required to detect a low state in the input signal. VIL is larger than the maximum single-ended line voltage during HS transmission. Therefore, both LP receivers will detect low during HS signaling. (9) This value includes a ground difference of 50 mV between the transmitter and the receiver, the status common-mode level tolerance and variations below 450 MHz. (10) Common mode is defined as the average voltage level of DX and DY: VCM = (V(DX) + V(DY))/2. Common mode ripple may be due to rise-fall time and transmission line impairments in the PCB. (11) Value when driving into differential load impedance anywhere in the range 80 to 125 . (12) ULPM stands for Ultra Low Power Mode. (13) UI = 1 / (2 * fh), where fh is the fundamental frequency of HS data transmission. For example, for 800 Mbps fh is 400 MHz. (14) vdda_x can be vdda_csiphy1 or vdda_csiphy2 depending on the interface used. (15) At minimum load. (16) At maximum load. Caution: This creates EMI parasitics up to 1.2 ns. (17) For more information about IOH / IOL values, see one of the tables in the Ball Characteristics section, column BUFFER DRIVE STRENGTH (mA) . (18) No VOL specifications are applicable in Standard mode. (19) For associated CBC and CUS balls, please refer to the Section 2.4, Multiplexing Characteristics table.
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
125
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
3.4
External Capacitors
To improve module performance, decoupling capacitors are required to suppress the switching noise generated by high frequency and to stabilize the supply voltage. A decoupling capacitor is most effective when it is close to the device, because this minimizes the inductance of the circuit board wiring and interconnects.
3.4.1
3.4.1.1
To improve module performance, decoupling capacitors are required to suppress the switching noise generated by high frequency and to stabilize the supply voltage. A decoupling capacitor is most effective when it is close to the device, because this minimizes the inductance of the circuit board wiring and interconnects. Table 3-6. Core Voltage Decoupling Characteristics
PARAMETER Cvdd_core (1) Cvdd_mpu_iva
(2)
MIN 0.6
MAX 1.8
UNIT F F
(1) The typical value corresponds to 2 capacitors of 470 nF, plus 3 capacitors of 100 nF. Except for the decoupling capacitance values, the PCB rules of the PCB Design Requirements for VDD_MPU_IVA Power Distribution Network for TI OMAP3630, AM37xx, and DM37xx Microprocessors (SPRABJ7) application note can be used. (2) For more information regarding the vdd_mpu_iva decoupling capacitance recommendations, see the PCB Design Requirements for VDD_MPU_IVA Power Distribution Network for TI OMAP3630, AM37xx, and DM37xx Microprocessors (SPRABJ7) application note.
3.4.1.2
Table 3-7 summarizes the power supply decoupling capacitor characteristics. Table 3-7. Power Supply Decoupling Capacitor Characteristics
PARAMETER Cvdds (1)(2) Cvdds_mem Cvdds_x (4) Cvdda_dplls_dll Cvdds_sram (4) Cvdda_wkup_bg_bb(4) Cvdda_dac
(4) (4) (1)(3)
TYP 400 700 100 100 100 100 220 470 100
MAX 600 1050 150 150 150 150 330 700 150
UNIT nF nF nF nF nF nF nF nF nF
Cvdds_mmc1 (4)
Cvdda_dpll_per (4)
(1) In power plan configuration. (2) The typical value corresponds to 4 capacitors of 100 nF. (3) The typical value corresponds to 7 capacitors of 100 nF. (4) In power rail configuration.
126
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
3.4.2
Output Capacitors
The capacitors at the outputs are required to stabilize the internal LDO supply voltages. The capacitors must be placed as close as possible to the balls. Table 3-8 summarizes the power supply decoupling characteristics. Table 3-8. Output Capacitor Characteristics
PARAMETER MIN 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 TYP 1 1 1 1 1 MAX 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 UNIT F F F F F
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
127
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
vdds_sram
Ccap_vdd_sram_mpu_iva
DPLL_MPU
vdda_dplls_dll
DLL
vdds_mem Cvdds_mem
vdds_mem
VDDS_MEM
DPLL5
vdda_dpll_per
vdda_dpll_per Cvdda_dpll_per
vdda_wkup_bg_bb Cvdda_wkup_bg_bb
BG vdda_wkup_bg_bb
DPLL4
BBLDO cap_vdd_bb_mpu_iva Ccap_vdd_bb_mpu_iva WKUP_LOGIC cap_vddu_wkup_logic Ccap_vddu_wkup_logic CORE cap_vddu_array Ccap_vddu_array vdds Cvdds vdds VDDS I/O vdd_core vdd_core Cvdd_core MPU vdd_mpu_iva vdd_mpu_iva Cvdd_mpu_iva
vss
OSCILLATOR
128
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
NOTE
Decoupling capacitors must be placed as closed as possible of the power ball. Choose the ground located closest to the power pin for each decoupling capacitor. In case of interconnecting powers, first insert the decoupling capacitor and then interconnect the powers. The decoupling capacitor value depends on the board characteristics.
3.5
3.5.1
Power-Up Sequence
NOTE
For more information, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management / PRCM Functional Description / PRCM Reset Manager Functional Description / Reset Sequences of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
129
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
1.8 V
1.1 V vdd_core
(1)
(1)
1.2 V supported. If an external square clock is provided, it could be started after sys_nrespwron release, provided it is clean, i.e. no glitch, stable frequency and duty cycle. sys_32k can be turned on any time between the vdds ramp-up and the sys_nrespwron release.
3.5.2
Power-Down Sequence
The following steps give two examples of power-down sequence supported by the DM37x device. 1. Put the DM37x device under reset (sys_nrespwron) 2. Stop all signals driven to its balls (sys_32k, sys_xtalin) 3. Either: (a) Shutdown all power domains at once. This sequence is described in black color in Figure 3-3. (b) Or, if the shutdown is sequenced, you must follow these steps (described in dash style blue color in Figure 3-3): Turn off all complex IO domains (vdds_mmc1, vdds_x) Turn off all the core and MPU domains (vdd_core, vdd_mpu_iva) Turn off all DPLL domains (vdda_dplls_dll, vdda_dpll_per) Turn off all sram LDOs (vdds_sram) Turn off all reference domains (vdda_wkup_bg_bb) Turn off all standard IO domains (vdds, vdds_mem) Figure 3-3 shows both power-down sequences: one of them is described in black color, and the other one in dash style blue.
130
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
sys_nrespwron
vdd_core vdd_mpu_iva
vdda_dplls_dll, vdda_dpll_per
vdds_sram
vdda_wkup_bg_bb
vdds, vdds_mem
sys_32k
sys_xtalin
A.
sys_32k can be turned off any time between the sys_nrespwron assertion and the vdds shut down.
Figure 3-3. Power-Down Sequence Alternate power-down sequence: vdd_mpu_iva shuts down before vdd_core. vdda_sram, vdda_wkup_bg_bb, vdds and vdds_mem shut down simultaneously. vdda_dplls_dll and vdda_dpll_per shut down anytime between all complex IO domains shut down and vdda_sram shuts down.
Electrical Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
131
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
4 Clock Specifications
NOTE
For more information, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management / PRCM Environment / External Clock Signal and Power, Reset and Clock Management / PRCM Functional Description / PRCM Clock Manager Functional Description sections of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (SPRUGN4).
Figure 4-1 shows external input clock sources and output clocks.
Device
sys_32k From power IC: 32 768-Hz
sys_altclk
sys_clkout1
To peripherals (from oscillator clock [sys_xtalin]): 12-,13-, 16.8-, 19.2-, 26-, or 38.4-MHz (no divider) To peripherals (from oscillator clock [sys_xtalin]): 12-,13-, 16.8-, 19.2-, 26-, or 38.4-MHz or Core_clk: up to 332 MHz (possible divider: 4, 8, 16) or DPLL 54-MHz, DPLL 96-MHz (possible divider: 1, 2, 4, 8, or 16) To quartz (oscillator output) or unconnected
sys_clkout2
sys_xtalout
sys_xtalin
sys_clkreq
sys_xtalout
sys_xtalout Unconnected
Oscillator is used
sys_xtalin
Oscillator is bypassed
sys_xtalin
sys_clkreq
GPin
sys_clkreq
132
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
The device operation requires the following three input clocks: The sys_32k 32-kHz clock is used for low frequency operation. It supplies the wake-up domain for operation in lowest power mode (off mode). This clock is provided through the sys_32k pin. The sys_altclk system alternative clock can be used (through the sys_altclk pin) to provide alternative 48 MHz or 54 MHz. The sys_xtalin / sys_xtalout system input clock (12, 13, 16.8, 19.2, 26, or 38.4 MHz) is used to generate the main source clock of the device. It supplies the DPLLs as well as several other modules. The system input clock can be connected to either: A crystal oscillator clock managed by sys_xtalin and sys_xtalout. In this case, the sys_clkreq is used as an input (GPIN). A CMOS digital clock through the sys_xtalin pin. In this case, the sys_clkreq is used as an output to request the external system clock. The device outputs externally two clocks: sys_clkout1 can output the oscillator clock (12, 13, 16.8, 19.2, 26, or 38.4 MHz) at any time. It can be controlled by software or externally using sys_clkreq control. When the device is in the off state, the sys_clkreq can be asserted to enable the oscillator and activate the sys_clkout1 without waking up the device. The off state polarity of sys_clkout1 is programmable. sys_clkout2 can output the oscillator clock (12, 13, 16.8, 19.2, 26, or 38.4 MHz), core_clk (core DPLL output), 96 MHz or 54 MHz. It can be divided by 2, 4, 8, or 16 and its off state polarity is programmable. This output is active only when the core power domain is active.
4.1 4.1.1
TRANSITION <10 ns 10 ns
sys_altclk
48 or 54 MHz
49% to 51%
10 ns
(1) 50 ppm is the clock frequency stability/accuracy and 5 ppm takes into account the aging effects. (2) Depending on the internal system clock divider configuration (PRCM.PRM_CLKSRC_CTRL[7:6], SYSCLKDIV bit field), the sys_xtalin input clock can be divided by 2 to provide the standard system clock (SYS_CLK) frequencies. For more information, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (SPRUGN4). In X%, X represents then the internal system clock divider with following possible values: X = 1 or 2. (3) tc(xtalin) is the sys_xtalin cycle time of the clock coming to sys_xtalin ball. (4) In this table, the transition times are calculated for 10%-90% of VDDS. For more information on the corresponding VDDS power supply name, please see the Ball Characteristics table corresponding to your package. The POWER column defines the VDDS power supply for each ball.
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
133
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
4.1.2
Device
sys_xtalin
sys_xtalgnd
sys_xtalout
Cf1
Cf2
Crystal
Figure 4-2. Crystal Implementation 1. When the crystal oscillator is in bypass mode (crystal implementation is unused), the sys_xtalgnd ball is not connected. The crystal must be in the fundamental mode of operation and parallel resonant. Table 4-2 summarizes the required electrical constraints. Table 4-2. Crystal Electrical Characteristics(1)
NAME fp Cf1 Cf2 DESCRIPTION Parallel resonance crystal frequency(1) Cf1 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 Cf2 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 12 MIN TYP 12, 13, 16.8, or 19.2 24 24 100 80 60 4.5 0.5 MAX UNIT MHz pF pF pF mW
ESR(Cf1,Cf2)(2) Frequency 12 MHz , Negative resistor at nominal 500 , Negative resistor at worst case 300 Frequency 13 MHz, Negative resistor at nominal 400 , Negative resistor at worst case 240 Frequency 16.8 MHz and 19.2 MHz, Negative resistor at nominal 300 , Negative resistor at worst case 180 Co DL Crystal shunt capacitance Crystal drive level
(1) Measured with the load capacitance specified by the crystal manufacturer. This load is defined by the foot capacitances tied in series. If CL = 20 pF, then both foot capacitors will be Cf1 = Cf2 = 40 pF. Parasitic capacitance from package and board must also be taken in account. (2) The crystal motional resistance Rm is related to the equivalent series resistance (ESR) by the following formula: ESR = Rm * (1 + (CO * Cf1 * Cf2 / (Cf1 + Cf2)))2.
When selecting a crystal, the system design must take into account the temperature and aging characteristics of a crystal versus the user environment and expected lifetime of the system.
134
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 4-3 details the switching characteristics of the oscillator and the requirements of the input clock. Table 4-3. Oscillator Switching CharacteristicsCrystal Mode
NAME fp tsX Oscillation frequency Start-up time(1) (2) 3 DESCRIPTION MIN TYP 12, 13, 16.8, or 19.2 MAX UNIT MHz ms
(1) Start-up time is defined as the time the oscillator takes to gain sys_xtalin amplitude enough to have 45% to 55% duty cycle at the core input from the time power down (PWRDN) is released. Start-up time is a strong function of crystal parameters. At power-on reset, the time is adjustable using the pin itself. The reset must be released when the oscillator or clock source is stable. To switch from bypass mode to crystal or from crystal mode to bypass mode, there is a waiting time about 100 s; however, if the chip comes from bypass mode to crystal mode then the crystal will start-up after time mentioned in the tsX parameter. (2) Before the processor boots up and the oscillator is set to bypass mode, there is a waiting time when the internal oscillator is in application mode and receives a square wave. The switching time in this case is about 100 s.
4.1.3
DESCRIPTION
UNIT MHz pF ms
(1) To switch from bypass mode to crystal mode or from crystal mode to bypass mode, there is a waiting time about 100 s; however, if the chip comes from bypass mode to crystal mode then the crystal will start-up after time mentioned in Table 4-3, tsX parameter above. (2) Before the processor boots up and the oscillator is set to bypass mode, there is a waiting time when the internal oscillator is in application mode and receives a square wave. The switching time in this case is about 100 s.
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
135
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 4-5 details the squarer input clock timing requirements. Table 4-5. sys_xtalin Squarer Input Clock Timing RequirementsBypass Mode
NAME OCS0 OCS1 DESCRIPTION 1 / tc(xtalin) tw(xtalin) tJ(xtalin) Frequency, sys_xtalin Pulse duration, sys_xtalin low or high Peak-to-peak jitter(1), sys_xtalin MIN 0.45 * tc(xtalin) TYP MAX 0.55 * tc(xtalin) X%(2) * tc(xtalin) (3) 200 10 10 +/-50 (+/-5ppm)(4) 12, 13, 16.8, 19.2, 26, or 38.4
(5)
UNIT MHz ns ps
ns ns ppm
Peak-to-peak jitter is meant here as follows: The maximum value is the difference between the longest measured clock period and the expected clock period The minimum value is the difference between the shortest measured clock period and the expected clock period Maximum and minimum are obtained on a statistical population of 300 period samples and expressed relative to the expected clock period
(2) Depending on the internal system clock divider configuration (PRCM.PRM_CLKSRC_CTRL[7:6], SYSCLKDIV bit field), the sys_xtalin input clock can be divided by 2 to provide the standard system clock (SYS_CLK) frequencies. For more information, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (SPRUGN4). In X%, X represents then the internal system clock divider with following possible values: X = 1 or 2. (3) tc(xtalin) is the sys_xtalin cycle time of the clock coming to sys_xtalin ball. (4) 50 ppm is the clock frequency stability/accuracy and 5 ppm takes into account the aging effects. (5) In this table, the transition times are calculated for 10%-90% of VDDS. For more information on the corresponding VDDS power supply name, please see the Ball Characteristics table corresponding to your package. The POWER column defines the VDDS power supply for each ball.
OSC0 sys_xtalin
SWPS038-008
OSC1
OSC1
4.1.4
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP 32.768
MAX 1.6
UNIT kHz pF M
106
details the input requirements of the sys_32k input clock. Table 4-7. sys_32k Input Clock Timing Requirements(1)
DESCRIPTION Frequency, sys_32k Rise time, sys_32k Fall time, sys_32k Frequency stability, sys_32k
MIN
TYP 32.768
MAX 10 10 200
136
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) In this table, the transition times are calculated for 10%-90% of VDDS. For more information on the corresponding VDDS power supply name, please see the Ball Characteristics table corresponding to your package. The POWER column defines the VDDS power supply for each ball.
CK0 sys_32k
SWPS038-009
CK1
CK1
4.1.5
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP 48 or 54
MAX 1.6
UNIT MHz pF M
10
Table 4-9 details the input requirements of the sys_altclk input clock. Table 4-9. sys_altclk Input Clock Timing Requirements(2)
NAME ALT0 ALT1 1 / tc(altclk) tw(altclk) tJ(altclk) tR(altclk) tF(altclk) tJ(altclk) DESCRIPTION Frequency, sys_altclk Pulse duration, sys_altclk low or high Peak-to-peak jitter(1), sys_altclk Rise time, sys_altclk Fall time, sys_altclk Frequency stability, sys_altclk 0.49 * tc(altclk) -1% MIN TYP 48 or 54 0.51 * tc(altclk) 1% 10 10 50 ns ns ppm MAX UNIT MHz ns
(1) Peak-to-peak jitter is meant here as follows: The maximum value is the difference between the longest measured clock period and the expected clock period The minimum value is the difference between the shortest measured clock period and the expected clock period Maximum and minimum are obtained on a statistical population of 300 period samples and expressed relative to the expected clock period (2) In this table, the transition times are calculated for 10%-90% of VDDS. For more information on the corresponding VDDS power supply name, please see the Ball Characteristics table corresponding to your package. The POWER column defines the VDDS power supply for each ball.
ALT0 sys_altclk
SWPS038-010
ALT1
ALT1
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
137
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
4.2 4.2.1
(1) The mode is configured by bits SC0 and SC1 of the IO cell. For more details, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (SPRUGN4).
Table 4-11 details the sys_clkout1 ouput clock switching characteristics. Table 4-11. sys_clkout1 Output Clock Switching Characteristics(6)
NAME CO0 SC[0:1] = 00(1) CL tJ tJC2C tW(CLKOUT1) tR(CLKOUT1) tF(CLKOUT1) SC[0:1] = 01
(1)
DESCRIPTION 1 / tc(CLKOUT1) Frequency, sys_clkout1 Load capacitance Peak-to-peak jitter Cycle-to-cycle jitter Pulse duration, sys_clkout1 low or high Rise time, sys_clkout1 Fall time, sys_clkout1 Load capacitance Peak-to-peak jitter Cycle-to-cycle jitter Pulse duration, sys_clkout1 low or high Rise time, sys_clkout1 Fall time, sys_clkout1 Load capacitance Peak-to-peak jitter Cycle-to-cycle jitter Pulse duration, sys_clkout1 low or high Rise time, sys_clkout1
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNIT MHz pF ps ps
ns ns pF ps ps
CL tJ tJC2C tW(CLKOUT1) tR(CLKOUT1) tF(CLKOUT1) SC[0:1] = 10(1) CL tJ tJC2C tW(CLKOUT1) tR(CLKOUT1) 138 Clock Specifications
0.55*tc(CLKOUT
1)
7(3) 7
(3)
ns ns pF ps ps
2 X 0.47*tc(CLKOUT
1) (5)
0.53*tc(CLKOUT 5(3) ns
0.4(2) (4)
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) The mode is configured by bits SC0 and SC1 of the IO cell. For more details, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (SPRUGN4). (2) At minimum load (3) At maximum load (Maximum frequency 20 MHz) (4) Caution: this creates EMI parasitics up to 1.2 ns (5) X parameter corresponds to the input jitter contribution added at sys_xtalin input pin. For more information regarding the sys_xtalin input jitter requirement, see Section 4.1.1. (6) In this table, the transition times are calculated for 10%-90% of VDDS. For more information on the corresponding VDDS power supply name, please see the Ball Characteristics table corresponding to your package. The POWER column defines the VDDS power supply for each ball.
CO0 sys_clkout1
SWPS038-011
CO1
CO1
4.2.2
NAME f CL ZT LT
DESCRIPTION Frequency, sys_clkout2 Load capacitance Transmission line impedance Transmission line length
MIN
TYP
MAX
(1)
UNIT MHz pF cm
or 54
22 70 6
Table 4-13 details the sys_clkout2 ouput clock switching characteristics. Table 4-13. sys_clkout2 Output Clock Switching Characteristics(8)
NAME CO0 DESCRIPTION 1 / tc(CLKOUT2) Frequency, sys_clkout2 tc(xtalin) tc(coredpll) tc(54mhz) tc(96mhz) CO1 tw(CLKOUT2) Cycle time, sys_xtalin Cycle time, core_dpll (DPLL3) (7) Cycle time, 54MHz clock (DPLL4) (7) Cycle time, 96MHz clock (DPLL4) (7) Pulse duration, sys_clkout2 low or high 0.49*tc(clkout 2) MIN TYP MAX UNIT MHz ns ns ns ns ns sys_xtalin clock or core_dpll clock(3) or 54 MHz, 96 MHz(4) 1 / sys_xtalin (MHz) 1 / core_dpll (MHz) 18.52 10.42 0.51*tc(clkout 2)
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
139
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
MIN
TYP
MAX X%(6) * tc(xtalin) + 200 4% * tc(coredpll) + 200 4% * tc(54mhz) + 200 4% * tc(96mhz) + 200
UNIT ps ps
ps ps ns ns
1.5(1) 1.5
(1)
5(2) 5(2)
CO1
CO1
4.3
The applicative subsystem integrates six DPLLs and a DLL. The PRM and CM drive those listed below. The main DPLLs are: DPLL1 (MPU) DPLL2 (IVA) DPLL3 (Core) DPLL4 (Peripherals) DPLL5 (Second peripherals DPLL)
140 Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
4.3.1
DPLL Characteristics
Table 4-14 summarizes the DPLL characteristics and assumes testing over recommended operating conditions. Table 4-14. DPLL1 - DPLL2 - DPLL3 - DPLL5 Characteristics
NAME vdda_dplls_dll vdda_dpll_per finput finternal fCLKINPHIF fCLKINPULOW fCLKOUT fCLKOUTx2 fCLKOUTHIF
DESCRIPTION Supply voltage for DPLLs (MPU, IVA, and Core) and DLL Supply voltage for DPLL (Peripherals) CLKINP Input frequency Internal reference frequency CLKINPHIF Input frequency CLKINPULOW Input frequency CLKOUT output frequency CLKOUTx2 output frequency CLKOUTHIF output frequency
MAX 1.91 1.91 52 52 1000 800 1000(2) 2000(2) 1000(4) 2000(4) 2000 1.9 + 350*REFCLK 1.9 + 500*REFCLK 1.9 + 70*REFCLK 1.9 + 120*REFCLK 0.05 + 70*REFCLK 0.05 + 120*REFCLK
COMMENTS
REFCLK FINPHIF
[M / (N + 1)] * FINP * [1 / M2] 2 * [M / (N + 1)] * FINP * [1 / M2] FINPHIF / M3 2 * [M / (N + 1)] * FINP * [1 / M3]
DCOCLKLDO output frequency Frequency lock time Phase lock time Relock timeFrequency lock(5) (Low power bypass) Relock timePhase lock(5) (Low power bypass) Relock timeFrequency lock(5) (Fast relock bypass) Relock timePhase lock(5) (Fast relock bypass)
20
MHz s s s s s s
2 * [M / (N + 1)] * FINP
DPLL in low-power mode: lowcurrstdby = 1 DPLL in low-power mode: lowcurrstdby = 1 DPLL in normal mode: lowcurrstdby = 0 DPLL in normal mode: lowcurrstdby = 0
(1) The minimum frequencies on CLKOUT and CLKOUTX2 are assuming M2 = 1. For M2 > 1, the minimum frequency on these clocks will further scale down by factor of M2. (2) The maximum frequencies on CLKOUT and CLKOUTX2 are assuming M2 = 1. (3) The minimum frequency on CLKOUTHIF is assuming M3 = 1. For M3 > 1, the minimum frequency on this clock will further scale down by factor of M3. (4) The maximum frequency on CLKOUTHIF is assuming M3 = 1. (5) Relock time assumes typical operating conditions, 10C maximum temperature drift.
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
141
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) The minimum frequency on CLKOUT is assuming M2 = 1. For M2 > 1, the minimum frequency on this clock will further scale down by factor of M2. (2) The maximum frequency on CLKOUT is assuming M2 = 1. (3) Relock time assumes typical operating conditions, 10C maximum temperature drift.
4.3.2
DLL Characteristics
Table 4-16 summarizes the DLL characteristics and assumes testing over recommended operating conditions. Table 4-16. DLL Characteristics
NAME DESCRIPTION Supply voltage for DPLLs (MPU, IVA, and Core) and DLL Input clock frequency Lock time Relock time (Mode transitions through idle mode)
(1)
MIN 1.71 66
COMMENTS
IDLE to MODEMAXDELAY IDLE to APPLICATION MODE 1 or 0 IDLE to APPLICATION MODE @133 MHz IDLE to APPLICATION MODE @166 MHz IDLE to APPLICATION MODE @200 MHz
142
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
4.3.3
030-017
A. B.
This circuit is provided only as an example. The filter must be located as close as possible to the device.
Figure 4-8. DPLL Noise Filter Table 4-17 specifies the noise filter requirements. Table 4-17. DPLL Noise Filter Requirements(1)
NAME Filtering capacitor MIN 50 TYP 100 MAX 150 UNIT nF
(1) For more information, see IO and Analog Voltage Decoupling Capacitors.
4.3.4
Processor Clocks
Table 4-18 through Table 4-20 show the clocks AC performance values. Table 4-18. Processor Voltages Without SmartReflexTM
RETENTIO N MIN MIN 0.92 OPP50 TYP 0.97 MAX 1.02 MIN 1.08 OPP100 TYP 1.14 MAX 1.2 MIN 1.21 OPP130(3) TYP 1.27 MAX 1.33
0.8
(1) At ball level. (2) Minimum OPP voltage values defined in this table include any voltage transient. (3) OPP130 is not available above TJ of 90C.
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
143
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) At ball level. (2) These VDD1 (vdd_mpu_iva) values are the required voltage ranges prior to enabling the SmartReflex AVS feature. After calibration, the minimum voltage may be lower than this specification. (3) Minimum OPP voltage values defined in this table include any voltage transient. (4) OPP130 and OPP1G are not available above TJ of 90C. (5) OPP1G is a high performance operating point which has following requirements: ABB LDO must be set to FBB (Forward Body Bias) mode when switching to this OPP. It requires having a 1F capacitor connected to cap_vdd_bb_mpu_iva. AVS (Adaptive Voltage Scaling) power technique must be used to achieve optimum operating voltage. (6) Based on DM3730 PCB constraints, the vdd_mpu_iva (VDD1) voltage value calibrated before enabling SmartReflex is recommended to be 1.38V. Minimum (1.28V) and typical (1.33V) values provided can be achieved only with very good power delivery network design. For more information on vdd_mpu_iva power delivery network design requirements, see the PCB Design Requirements for VDD_MPU_IVA Power Distribution Network for TI OMAP3630, AM37xx, and DM37xx Microprocessors (SPRABJ7) application note.
300
2 *(M2 = 2)(1)(4) -
600
2 *(M2 = 1)(1)(4) -
800
2 *(M2 = 1)(1)(4) -
1000
2 *(M2 = 1)(1)(4) -
1040
1040
1320
1600
260
2 *(M2 = 2)(1)(4) 1 1
520
2 *(M2 = 2)(1)(4) 1 1
660
2 *(M2 = 2)(1)(4) 1 1
800
2 *(M2 = 2)(1)(4) 1 1
300 260
600 520
800 660
1000 800
(1) This ratio is configurable by software programming. For more information, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (SPRUGN4). (2) OPP1G is a high performance operating point which has following requirements: ABB LDO must be set to FBB (Forward Body Bias) mode when switching to this OPP. It requires having a 1F capacitor connected to cap_vdd_bb_mpu_iva. AVS (Adaptive Voltage Scaling) power technique must be used to achieve optimum operating voltage. (3) For more information about ARM_FCLK and IVA2_CLK processor clocks configuration, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management / PRCM Functional Description / PRCM Clock Manager Functional Description / Clock Configurations / Processor Clock Configurations section or the MPU Subsystem / MPU Subsystem Integration / MPU Subsystem Clock and Reset Distribution / Clock Distribution section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (SPRUGN4). (4) The DPLL ratios documented in this table are recommended ratios. Other values may apply.
144
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
4.3.5
VDD2
(V)
0.8
(1) At ball level. (2) Minimum OPP voltage values defined in this table include any voltage transient. (3) When SmartReflex is not used, these values define the required voltage range. When SmartReflex will be used, these voltages are the required voltage range prior to enabling the SmartReflex feature. After calibration, the minimum voltage may be lower than this specification.
2 *(M2 = 2)(1)(2)
166
2 *(M2 = 1)(1)(2)
200
2 *(M2 = 1)(1)(2)
400
2 *(M2 = 1)(1)(2)
332
2 *(M2 = 1)(1)(2)
266
2 *(M2 = 1)(1)(2)
166
200
400
332
266
83 41.5 83 41.5
100 50 100 50
166 83 166 83
GPMC_C L3_ICLK LK
(1) This ratio is configurable by software programming. For more information, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (SPRUGN4). (2) The DPLL ratios documented in this table are recommended ratios. Other values may apply.
4.3.6
1.08
(2) SGX (Graphic Accelerator) is not available in the OPP50 operating point. (3) When SmartReflex is not used, these values define the required voltage range. When SmartReflex will be used, these voltages are the required voltage range prior to enabling the SmartReflex feature. After calibration, the minimum voltage may be lower than this specification. (4) Minimum OPP voltage values defined in this table include any voltage transient.
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
145
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) This ratio is configurable by software programming. For more information, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (SPRUGN4). (2) SGX (Graphic Accelerator) is not available in OPP50 operating point. (3) The DPLL ratios documented in this table are recommended ratios. Other values may apply.
146
Clock Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
5.1
The connection for this TVOUT buffer mode (DAC + Buffer) normal mode of operation is shown in Figure 5-1. The default mode of operation is dc coupling. For more information regarding the recommended values of the external components, see Section 5.4, Electrical Specifications Over Recommended Operating Conditions.
AVDAC
vssa_dac vdda_dac
I DAC + TVBUF
VREF
TVDET
= External pin
swps038-125
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
147
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
5.2
vssa_dac vdda_dac
I DAC + TVBUF
OFF
VREF
OFF
= External pin
TVDET
swps038-131
148
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
5.3
Figure 5-3. Recommended Loading Conditions for TVOUT Bypass Mode in Dual-Channel Configuration(1)
(1) Here are some connections recommendations: An external resistor RSET = 10 k (1%) is recommended to be connected to the cvideo1_rset signal of Channel 1. The cvideo1_rset signal of Channel 2 is left unconnected. External resistors RLOAD1LOAD2 = 1.5 k (1%) is recommended to be connected to cvideo1_vfb or cvideo2_vfb each channel.
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
149
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
5.4
TVOUT DC High Swing Mode: ROUT1/2 = 2.7 k (1%) RSET = 4.7 k (1%) RLOAD = 75 (5%) ZCABLE = 75 (5%) TVOUT DC Low Swing Mode: ROUT1/2 = 2.7 k (1%) RSET = 6.8 k (1%) RLOAD = 75 (5%) ZCABLE = 75 (5%) TVOUT AC High Swing Mode: ROUT1/2 = 2.7 k (1%) RSET = 4.7 k (1%) RLOAD = 75 (5%) ZCABLE = 75 (5%) CAC = 220 F (5%) TVOUT AC Low Swing Mode: ROUT1/2 = 2.7 k (1%) RSET = 6.8 k (1%) RLOAD = 75 (5%) ZCABLE = 75 (5%) CAC = 220 F (5%) Table 5-1. DAC Static Electrical Specifications(8)
PARAMETER CONDITIONS/ASSUMPTIONS MIN TYP 10 50 to 111 input code range 111 to 895 input code range 783 to 1007 input code range 111 to 895 input code range 0 to 1023 input code range, RLOAD = 75 Low-swing mode High-swing mode Low-swing mode High-swing mode 6 4 5 2.5 0.70 1.2 20 10 67.5 75.0 0.55 0.88 1.3 6 4 5 2.5 1.00 1.5 20 10 82.5 V % FS LSB V MAX UNIT Bits LSB
R INL(1)
Resolution Integral Non-Linearity (INL) Integral Non-Linearity (INL) Signal video range Integral Non-Linearity (INL) Synchronization pulse
DC ACCURACY
DNL(2) -
ANALOG OUTPUT
150
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
CONDITIONS/ASSUMPTIONS Average current on vdda_dac, no load, 2 channels Input code 50 (maximum output voltage)
MIN 4.5 19 19
TYP 6.5 28 28 60
MAX 8.5 37 37
UNIT mA
Lasts less than 1 ns Average current, measured at fCLK = 54 MHz, fOUT = 2 MHz sine wave, vdd = 1.1 V Peak current, full-scale transition lasting less than 1 ns T = 30C, vdda_dac = 1.8 V, no load Bandgap and internal LDO are ON, all other analog blocks are OFF, no load, T = 30 C T = 30C, Full Low-swing mode or Partial Power High-swing mode Management T = 30C, VDD = 1.1 V, no Power Management 90
mA 2 mA
Peak digital supply current(6) Analog supply current, total power down(9) Analog supply current, standby mode(9)
8 12 180 270
mA A A
Ivdd-down(pm)(9)
Digital supply current, total power down(9) Digital supply current, total power down (no power management)
2 6 60
Ivdd-down(nopm)
(1) The INL is measured at the output of the DAC (accessible at an external pin during bypass mode). The INL at code 783 equals 0. (2) The DNL is measured at the output of the DAC (accessible at an external pin during bypass mode). The INL at code 783 equals 0. (3) Reference PSR measures the effect of a supply disturbance at cvideo1_out and cvideo2_out. (4) The analog supply current Ivdda is directly proportional to the full-scale output current IFS and is insensitive to fCLK. (5) The digital supply current IVDD is dependent on the digital input waveform, the DAC update rate fCLK, and the digital supply VDD. (6) The peak digital supply current occurs at full-scale transition for duration less than 1 ns. (7) See Section 5.6, Analog Supply (vdda_dac) Noise Requirements, for actual maximum ripple allowed on vdda_dac. (8) For more information on code range definition, see Figure 5-4. (9) For more information on AVDAC power-up, power-down, and standby mode configurations, see Display Subsystem / Display Subsystem Functional Description / Video Encoder Functionalities / Video DAC Stage Power Management section of AM/DM37x Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
NOTE
High-swing mode is the default mode. The low-swing mode is not compliant with the NTSC and PAL video-standards. It is used only for backwards compatibility to AM/DM37x.
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
151
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
CONDITIONS/ASSUMPTIONS Equal to input clock frequency RMS clock jitter required in order to assure 10-bit accuracy Corner frequency for signal 3 dB 111 to 895 input code range 111 to 895 input code range DC mode AC mode DC mode AC mode DC mode AC mode DC mode AC mode DC mode AC mode DC mode AC mode
MIN
TYP 54 40
MAX 60 70 1.5
6 5% 5% 3 3 40 50 5% 5% 3 3 70
Within bandwidth 1 kHz to fCLK = 54 MHz, fOUT = 1 6 MHz MHz, sine wane input, 111 to 895 input code range Within bandwidth 1 kHz to fCLK = 54 MHz, fOUT = 1 6 MHz MHz, sine wane input, 256 to 768 input code range
dB
SNR
50
54
75
dB
Power supply rejection (up 100 mVpp at 6 MHz, input code 895 to 6 MHz) Between the two video channels TVOUT (cvideo_out1 and cvideo_out2) stability, TVOUT decoupling capacity TVOUT stability, total TVOUT decoupling capacity Total decoupling capacity from cvideo_out1 or cvideo_out2 to ground, CLoad1 Total decoupling capacity: CTOT = CLoad1 + CLoad2
6(4) 50 40 300
dB dB pF
CTOT
600
pF
(1) For internal input clock information, see the DSS chapter of AM/DM37x Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (2) The differential gain and phase value is for dc coupling. Note that there is degradation for the ac coupling. The Differential Gain and Phase are measured with respect to the gain and phase of the burst signal (20 to 20 IRE) (3) The SNR value is for dc coupling. (4) PSR measures the effect of a supply disturbance at cvideo1_out and cvideo2_out. (5) The flat band measurement is done at 500 kHz for characterizing the attenuation at 5.1 MHz. (6) For more information on code range definition, see Figure 5-4.
152
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
223
100
1.3 Vpp*
741 783
A D N O A E T S VID GE N A R
20 7.5 0 -20 -40 Sync level
D R
White level
895
1007 1023
SWPS038-130
5.5
TVOUT Bypass Mode Specifications (DAC-Only) Electrical Specifications Over Recommended Operating Conditions
NOTE
The electrical characteristics for single- and dual-channel bypass modes are the same except that the active current will double in the dual-channel configuration.
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
153
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Bypass Mode RLOAD = 1.5 k (1%) RSET = 10 k (1%) Table 5-3. DACStatic Electrical SpecificationsBypass Mode(2)
PARAMETER CONDITIONS/ASSUMPTIONS MIN TYP 10 37 to 954 input code range, RLOAD = 1.5 k 37 to 954 input code range, RLOAD = 1.5 k RLOAD = 1.5 k RLOAD = 1.5 k Average current on vdda_dac, RLOAD = 1.5 k Input code 1023 T = 30C, vdda_dac = 1.8 V, no load Bandgap and internal LDO are ON, all other analog blocks are OFF, no load, T = 30C 90 180 1 1 0.6 0.6 10 0.7 1.0 0.7 0.7 1 1 0.77 0.77 10 1.4 12 270 MAX UNIT Bits LSB LSB V V % FS mA A A
Resolution Integral nonlinearity (INL) Differential nonlinearity Output voltage Output current Gain error Analog supply current Analog supply current, total power down Analog supply current, standby mode
DC ACCURACY
ANALOG OUTPUT
POWER CONSUMPTION
(1) In bypass mode, output node is cvideo1_out and cvideo2_out nodes. For more information, see Section 5.2, TVOUT Bypass Mode (DAC Only) or Section 5.3, TVOUT Bypass Mode in Dual-Channel Configuration. (2) For more information on code range definition, see Figure 5-4.
SNR
50
54
75
dB
PSR
6(1)
dB
(1) For more information on code range definition, see Figure 5-4.
5.6
154
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Depending on frequency, the PSRR is defined in Table 5-5. Table 5-5. Video DAC Power Supply Rejection Ratio
Supply Noise Frequency 0 to 100 kHz > 100 kHz PSRR % FSR/V 1 The rejection decreases 20 dB/dec. Example: at 1 MHz the PSRR is 10% of FSR/V.
Figure 5-5. Video DAC Power Supply Rejection Ratio To ensure that the DAC SFDR specification is met, the PSRR values and the clock jitter requirements translate to the following limits on vdda_dac (for the Video DAC). The maximum peak-to-peak noise on vdda (ripple) is defined in Table 5-6. Table 5-6. Video DAC Maximum Peak-to-Peak Noise on vdda_dac
Tone Frequency 0 to 100 kHz > 100 kHz Maximum Peak-to-Peak Noise on vdda_dac < 30 mVPP Decreases 20 dB/dec. Example: at 1 MHz the maximum is 3 mVPP
The maximum noise spectral density (white noise) is defined in Table 5-7. Table 5-7. Video DAC Maximum Noise Spectral Density
Supply Noise Bandwidth 0 to 100 kHz > 100 kHz Maximum Supply Noise Density < 20 V / Hz Decreases 20 dB/dec. Example: at 1 MHz the maximum noise density is 2 V / Hz
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
155
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Because the DAC PSRR deteriorates at a rate of 20 dB/dec after 100 kHz, it is highly recommended to have vdda_dac low pass filtered (proper decoupling) (see the illustrated application: Section 5.7, External Component Value Choice).
156
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
5.7
Video DAC Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
157
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.2 6.2.1
6.2.2
6.2.3
SWPS038-013
6.2.4
158
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
6.3
Timing Parameters
The timing parameter symbols used in the timing requirements and switching characteristics tables are created in accordance with JEDEC Standard 100. To shorten the symbols, some of pin names and other related terminologies have been abbreviated as follows: Table 6-1. Timing Parameters
SUBSCRIPTS SYMBOL c d dis en h su START t v w X F H L R V IV AE FE LE Z Cycle time (period) Delay time Disable time Enable time Hold time Setup time Start bit Transition time Valid time Pulse duration (width) Unknown, changing, or dont care level Fall time High Low Rise time Valid Invalid Active edge First edge Last edge High impedance PARAMETER
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
159
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.4
6.4.1
The GPMC is the unified memory controller used to interface external memory devices such as: Asynchronous SRAM-like memories and ASIC devices Asynchronous page mode and synchronous burst NOR flash NAND flash 6.4.1.1 GPMC/NOR FlashSynchronous Mode
Table 6-3 and Table 6-4 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-2 through Figure 6-6). Table 6-2. GPMC/NOR Flash Timing ConditionsSynchronous Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 1.8 1.8 12 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
(18)
UNIT MHz ns ns
0.5P(12)
0.5P(12)
160
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 (18)
(continued)
UNIT 500 33.33 1.6 1.6 2 2 ps ps ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns MAX
+ 3.3 F
(6)
1.9 F
(6)
+ 3.3
E(5) 1.9 E(5) + 3.3 E(5) 1.9 E(5) + 3.3 B(2) 4.1 B(2) + 2.1 B(2) 4.1 B(2) + 2.1 2.1 2.1
F7
td(clkH-nbeIV)
Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to D(4) 2.2 D(4) + 1.2 D(4) 2.2 D(4) + 1.2 output lower byte enable/command latch enable gpmc_nbe0_cle, output upper byte enable gpmc_nbe1 invalid Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to output address valid/address latch enable gpmc_nadv_ale transition Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to output address valid/address latch enable gpmc_nadv_ale invalid Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to output enable gpmc_noe transition Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to output enable gpmc_noe invalid Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to output write enable gpmc_nwe transition Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to output data gpmc_d[15:0] transition Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to output lower byte enable/command latch enable gpmc_nbe0_cle transition Pulse duration, output chip select gpmc_ncsx(11) low Pulse duration, output lower byte enable/command latch enable gpmc_nbe0_cle, output upper byte enable gpmc_nbe1 low Pulse duration, output address valid/address latch enable gpmc_nadv_ale low Read Write Read Write Read Write G(7) + 0.8 G(7) + 2.2 G(7) + 0.8 G(7) + 2.2
ns
F8
td(clkH-nadv)
ns
F9
td(clkH-nadvIV)
ns
H(8) 2.1 H(8) + 2.1 H(8) 2.1 H(8) + 2.1 E(5) 2.1 E(5) + 2.1 E(5) 2.1 E(5) + 2.1 I(9) 1.9 J(10) 1.7 J(10) 2.2 A(1) A
(1)
ns ns ns ns ns
F18 F19
tw(ncsV) tw(nbeV)
A(1) A
(1)
ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
F20
tw(nadvV)
F23
td(clkH-iodir)
Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to output IO direction control gpmc_io_dir high (IN direction) Delay time, output clock gpmc_clk rising edge to output IO direction control gpmc_io_dir low (OUT direction)
F24
td(clkH-iodirIV)
M(17) 2.1
M(17) + 4.1
M(17) 2.1
M(17) + 4.1
ns
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
161
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) For single read: A = (CSRdOffTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) For burst read: A = (CSRdOffTime CSOnTime + (n 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) For burst write: A = (CSWrOffTime CSOnTime + (n 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) With n being the page burst access number. (2) B = ClkActivationTime * GPMC_FCLK(14) (3) For single read: C = RdCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (14) For burst read: C = (RdCycleTime + (n 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) For burst write: C = (WrCycleTime + (n 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) With n being the page burst access number. (4) For single read: D = (RdCycleTime AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) For burst read: D = (RdCycleTime AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) For burst write: D = (WrCycleTime AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (5) For single read: E = (CSRdOffTime AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) For burst read: E = (CSRdOffTime AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) For burst write: E = (CSWrOffTime AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (6) For nCS falling edge (CS activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if (ClkActivationTime and CSOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and CSOnTime are even) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((CSOnTime ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((CSOnTime ClkActivationTime 1) is a multiple of 3) F = (2 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((CSOnTime ClkActivationTime 2) is a multiple of 3) (7) For ADV falling edge (ADV activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if (ClkActivationTime and ADVOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVOnTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((ADVOnTime ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((ADVOnTime ClkActivationTime 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((ADVOnTime ClkActivationTime 2) is a multiple of 3) For ADV rising edge (ADV deactivated) in Reading mode: Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if (ClkActivationTime and ADVRdOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVRdOffTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((ADVRdOffTime ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((ADVRdOffTime ClkActivationTime 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((ADVRdOffTime ClkActivationTime 2) is a multiple of 3) For ADV rising edge (ADV deactivated) in Writing mode: Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if (ClkActivationTime and ADVWrOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVWrOffTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((ADVWrOffTime ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((ADVWrOffTime ClkActivationTime 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((ADVWrOffTime ClkActivationTime 2) is a multiple of 3) (8) For OE falling edge (OE activated) / IO DIR rising edge (Data Bus input direction): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: o H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if (ClkActivationTime and OEOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and OEOnTime are even) H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((OEOnTime ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) 162 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((OEOnTime ClkActivationTime 1) is a multiple of 3) H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((OEOnTime ClkActivationTime 2) is a multiple of 3)
For OE rising edge (OE deactivated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if (ClkActivationTime and OEOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and OEOffTime are even) H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((OEOffTime ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((OEOffTime ClkActivationTime 1) is a multiple of 3) H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((OEOffTime ClkActivationTime 2) is a multiple of 3) (9) For WE falling edge (WE activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if (ClkActivationTime and WEOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and WEOnTime are even) I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((WEOnTime ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((WEOnTime ClkActivationTime 1) is a multiple of 3) I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((WEOnTime ClkActivationTime 2) is a multiple of 3) For WE rising edge (WE deactivated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK (14) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if (ClkActivationTime and WEOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and WEOffTime are even) I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((WEOffTime ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((WEOffTime ClkActivationTime 1) is a multiple of 3) I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) if ((WEOffTime ClkActivationTime 2) is a multiple of 3) (10) J = GPMC_FCLK(14) (11) In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7. In gpmc_waitx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, or 3. (12) P = gpmc_clk period in ns (13) For read: K = (ADVRdOffTime ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) For write: K = (ADVWrOffTime ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (14) GPMC_FCLK is general-purpose memory controller internal functional clock period in ns. (15) Related to the gpmc_clk output clock maximum and minimum frequencies programmable in the GPMC module by setting the GPMC_CONFIG1_CSx configuration register bit field GpmcFCLKDivider. (16) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (17) M = (RdCycleTime AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) Above M parameter expression is given as one example of GPMC programming. IO DIR signal will go from IN to OUT after both RdCycleTime and BusTurnAround completion. Behavior of IO direction signal does depend on kind of successive Read/Write accesses performed to Memory and multiplexed or nonmultiplexed memory addressing scheme, bus keeping feature enabled or not. IO DIR behaviour is automatically handled by GPMC controller. For a full description of the gpmc_io_dir feature, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (18) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
163
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 F18 gpmc_ncsx F4 gpmc_a[10:1] F6 F19 gpmc_nbe0_cle F19 gpmc_nbe1 F6 F8 F20 gpmc_nadv_ale F10 gpmc_noe F13 F12 gpmc_d[15:0] D0 F11 F8 F9 Valid Address F7 F3 F1
(1) (2)
164
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 gpmc_ncsx F4 gpmc_a[10:1] F6 gpmc_nbe0_cle F7 gpmc_nbe1 F6 gpmc_nadv_ale F10 gpmc_noe F13 F12 gpmc_d[15:0] F21 gpmc_waitx F23 gpmc_io_dir OUT IN F24 OUT
SWPS038-015
F1
F3
Valid Address F7
F8
F8
F9
F11
F13 F12
D0 F22
D1
D2
D3
(1) (2)
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
165
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
F1 F1 gpmc_clk F2 gpmc_ncsx F4 gpmc_a[10:1] Valid Address F17 F6 gpmc_nbe0_cle F17 F17 gpmc_nbe1 F6 gpmc_nadv_ale F14 gpmc_nwe F15 gpmc_d[15:0] gpmc_waitx D0 D1 F15 D2 F15 D3 F14 F8 F8 F9 F17 F17 F17 F3 F0
gpmc_io_dir
OUT
SWPS038-016
(1) (2)
166
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 gpmc_ncsx F6 gpmc_nbe0_cle F6 gpmc_nbe1 F4 gpmc_a[27:17] (gpmc_a[11:1]) F4 gpmc_a[16:1] (gpmc_d[15:0]) gpmc_nadv_ale F10 gpmc_noe gpmc_waitx F11 Address (LSB) F8 F8 Address (MSB) F12 F5 D0 F13 D1 D2 F9 F12 D3 Valid Valid F7 F7 F3 F1
F24 OUT
SWPS038-017
(1) (2)
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
167
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
F1 F1 gpmc_clk F2 F18 gpmc_ncsx F4 gpmc_a[27:17] (gpmc_a[11:1]) F6 gpmc_nbe1 F17 F6 gpmc_nbe0_cle F8 gpmc_nadv_ale F14 gpmc_nwe F15 gpmc_a[16:1] (gpmc_d[15:0]) gpmc_waitx gpmc_io_dir OUT
SWPS038-018
F0 F3
F17 F8 F20
F17
F9
D0 F21
D1
(1) (2)
168
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
6.4.1.2
Table 6-6 and Table 6-7 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-7 through Figure 6-12). Table 6-5. GPMC/NOR Flash Timing ConditionsAsynchronous Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 1.8 1.8 16 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
(4)
MAX
ns ns ps ps
(1) The internal parameters table must be used to calculate data access time stored in the corresponding CS register bit field. (2) Internal parameters are referred to the GPMC functional internal clock which is not provided externally. (3) GPMC_FCLK is general-purpose memory controller internal functional clock. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
169
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
PARAMETER tacc(d) tacc1-pgmode(d) tacc2-pgmode(d) Data access time Page mode successive data access time Page mode first data access time
UNIT ns ns ns
(1) The FA5 parameter illustrates the amount of time required to internally sample input data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input data is internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value must be stored inside the AccessTime register bit field. (2) The FA21 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample first input page data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA21 functional clock cycles, first input page data is internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA21 value must be stored inside the AccessTime register bit field. (3) The FA20 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample successive input page data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. After each access to input page data, next input page data is internally sampled by active functional clock edge after FA20 functional clock cycles. The FA20 value must be stored in the PageBurstAccessTime register bit field. (4) P = PageBurstAccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(6) (5) H = AccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(6) (6) GPMC_FCLK is general-purpose memory controller internal functional clock period in ns. (7) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
UNIT ns ns ns
FA1 FA3
tw(ncsV) td(ncsV-nadvIV)
ns ns
B(2) + 2.0 B
(2)
B(2) + 2.6 B
(2)
+ 2.0
0.2
+ 2.6 ns
FA4
td(ncsV-noeIV)
Delay time, output chip select gpmc_ncsx(13) valid to output enable gpmc_noe invalid (Single read) Delay time, output address gpmc_a[27:1] valid to output chip select gpmc_ncsx(13) valid Delay time, output lower-byte enable/command latch enable gpmc_nbe0_cle, output upper-byte enable gpmc_nbe1 valid to output chip select gpmc_ncsx(13) valid Delay time, output chip select gpmc_ncsx(13) valid to output address valid/address latch enable gpmc_nadv_ale valid Delay time, output chip select gpmc_ncsx(13) valid to output enable gpmc_noe valid Delay time, output chip select gpmc_ncsx(13) valid to output IO direction control gpmc_io_dir high
C(3) 0.2
C(3) + 2.0
C(3) 0.2
C(3) + 2.6
FA9 FA10
td(aV-ncsV) td(nbeV-ncsV)
ns ns
FA12
td(ncsV-nadvV)
K(10) 0.2
K(10) + 2.0
K(10) 0.2
K(10) + 2.6
ns
FA13 FA14
td(ncsV-noeV) td(ncsV-iodir)
(11)
ns ns
L(11) 0.2
FA15
td(ncsV-iodir)
Delay time, output chip select gpmc_ncsx(13) M(14) 0.2 M(14) + 2.0 M(14) 0.2 M(14) + 2.6 valid to output IO direction control gpmc_io_dir low
ns
170
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
D(4) E(5) 0.2 F(6) 0.2 E(5) + 2.0 F(6) + 2.0 2.0 J(9) + 2.0 2.0
D(4) E(5) 0.2 F(6) 0.2 E(5) + 2.6 F(6) + 2.6 2.6 J(9) 0.2 J(9) + 2.6 2.6
ns ns ns ns ns ns
(1) For single read: A = (CSRdOffTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(15) For single write: A = (CSWrOffTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(15) For burst read: A = (CSRdOffTime CSOnTime + (n 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(15) For burst write: A = (CSWrOffTime CSOnTime + (n 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(15) with n being the page burst access number (2) For reading: B = ((ADVRdOffTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(15) For writing: B = ((ADVWrOffTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (3) C = ((OEOffTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (4) D = PageBurstAccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (5) E = ((WEOnTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (6) F = ((WEOffTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (7) G = Cycle2CycleDelay * GPMC_FCLK(15) (8) I = ((OEOffTime + (n 1) * PageBurstAccessTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (9) J = (CSOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (10) K = ((ADVOnTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (11) L = ((OEOnTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (12) For single read: N = RdCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(15) For single write: N = WrCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(15) For burst read: N = (RdCycleTime + (n 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(15) For burst write: N = (WrCycleTime + (n 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(15) (13) In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7. (14) M = ((RdCycleTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(15) Above M parameter expression is given as one example of GPMC programming. IO DIR signal will go from IN to OUT after both RdCycleTime and BusTurnAround completion. Behavior of IO direction signal does depend on kind of successive Read/Write accesses performed to Memory and multiplexed or nonmultiplexed memory addressing scheme, bus keeping feature enabled or not. IO DIR behaviour is automatically handled by GPMC controller. For a full description of the gpmc_io_dir feature, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (15) GPMC_FCLK is general-purpose memory controller internal functional clock period in ns. (16) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
171
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA5 FA1 gpmc_ncsx FA9 gpmc_a[10:1] Valid Address FA0 FA10 gpmc_nbe0_cle Valid FA0 gpmc_nbe1 FA10 FA12 gpmc_nadv_ale FA4 FA13 gpmc_noe gpmc_d[15:0] Data IN 0 Data IN 0 FA3 Valid
gpmc_waitx
(1) (2)
(3)
In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7. In gpmc_waitx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, or 3. FA5 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value must be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally.
172
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk
FA5 FA1 FA5 FA1
gpmc_ncsx
FA16 FA9 FA9 Address 0 FA0 FA10 FA10 Valid FA0 Valid FA0 Valid FA10 Address 1 FA0
gpmc_a[10:1]
gpmc_nbe0_cle gpmc_nbe1
FA10
Valid
FA3 FA12
FA3 FA12
gpmc_nadv_ale
FA4 FA13 FA13 FA4
FA15
gpmc_io_dir
OUT
(1) (2)
(3)
In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7. In gpmc_waitx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, or 3. FA5 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value must be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
173
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
GPMC_FCLK
gpmc_clk FA21 FA1 gpmc_ncsx FA9 gpmc_a[10:1] FA10 gpmc_nbe0_cle FA0 FA10 gpmc_nbe1 FA12 gpmc_nadv_ale FA18 FA13 gpmc_noe gpmc_d[15:0] D0 D1 D2 D3 D3
Add0 Add1 Add2 Add3
FA20
FA20
FA20
Add4
FA0
(1) (2)
(3)
(4)
In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7. In gpmc_waitx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, or 3. FA21 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample first input page data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA21 functional clock cycles, first input page data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA21 calculation must be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. FA20 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample successive input page data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. After each access to input page data, next input page data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge after FA20 functional clock cycles. FA20 is also the duration of address phases for successive input page data (excluding first input page data). FA20 value must be stored in PageBurstAccessTime register bits field. GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally.
174
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
gpmc_fclk gpmc_clk
FA1
gpmc_ncsx
FA9
gpmc_a[10:1]
FA10
gpmc_nbe0_cle
FA0 FA10
gpmc_nbe1
FA3 FA12
gpmc_nadv_ale
FA27 FA25
gpmc_nwe
FA29
Data OUT
OUT
SWPS038-022
(1)
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
175
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA1 FA5 gpmc_ncsx FA9 gpmc_a[27:17] (gpmc_a[11:1]) FA10 gpmc_nbe0_cle FA10 gpmc_nbe1 FA3 FA12 gpmc_nadv_ale FA4 FA13 gpmc_noe FA29 gpmc_a[16:1] (gpmc_d[15:0])
Address (LSB) Valid Valid Address (MSB)
FA0
FA0
FA37
Data IN Data IN
OUT
IN
OUT
(1) (2)
(3)
In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7. In gpmc_waitx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, or 3. FA5 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value must be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally.
176
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
gpmc_fclk gpmc_clk FA1 gpmc_ncsx FA9 gpmc_a[27:17] (gpmc_a[11:1]) FA10 gpmc_nbe0_cle FA0 FA10 gpmc_nbe1 FA3 FA12 gpmc_nadv_ale FA27 FA25 gpmc_nwe FA29 gpmc_a[16:1] (gpmc_d[15:0]) gpmc_waitx gpmc_io_dir
OUT
SWPS038-024
Address (MSB)
FA0
FA28
Data OUT
(1)
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
177
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.4.1.3
Table 6-10 and Table 6-11 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-13 through Figure 6-16). Table 6-9. GPMC/NAND Flash Timing ConditionsAsynchronous Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 1.8 1.8 16 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
(2) (4)
GNFI5
6.5
9.1
ns
ns ns ps
(1) Internal parameters table must be used to calculate data access time stored in the corresponding CS register bit field. (2) Internal parameters are referred to the GPMC functional internal clock which is not provided externally. (3) GPMC_FCLK is general-purpose memory controller internal functional clock. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
(1) The GNF12 parameter illustrates the amount of time required to internally sample input data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of the read cycle and after GNF12 functional clock cycles, input data is internally sampled by the active functional clock edge. The GNF12 value must be stored inside AccessTime register bit field. (2) J = AccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(3) (3) GPMC_FCLK is general-purpose memory controller internal functional clock period in ns. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
178
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
UNIT ns ns ns ns ns
ns ns ns
GNF6
tw(nweIV-ncsIV)
G(7) 0.2
G(7) + 2.0
G(7) 0.2
G(7) + 2.6
ns
GNF7
tw(aleH-nweV)
C(3) 0.2
C(3) + 2.0
C(3) 0.2
C(3) + 2.6
ns
GNF8
tw(nweIV-aleIV)
F(6) 0.2
F(6) + 2.0
F(6) 0.2
F(6) + 2.6
ns
H(8) I
(9)
H(8) I
(9)
ns I(9) + 2.6 ns ns ns ns
0.2
+ 2.0
(9)
0.2
K(10) L
(11)
K(10) L(11)
(1) A = (WEOffTime WEOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (2) B = ((WEOnTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (3) C = ((WEOnTime ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay ADVExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (4) D = (WEOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (5) E = ((WrCycleTime WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (6) F = ((ADVWrOffTime WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay WEExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (7) G = ((CSWrOffTime WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (CSExtraDelay WEExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (8) H = WrCycleTime * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (9) I = ((OEOnTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (10) K = (OEOffTime OEOnTime) * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (11) L = RdCycleTime * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (12) M = ((CSRdOffTime OEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (CSExtraDelay OEExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK(14) (13) In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7. (14) GPMC_FCLK is general-purpose memory controller internal functional clock period in ns. (15) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
179
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
GPMC_FCLK GNF1 gpmc_ncsx GNF2 gpmc_nbe0_cle gpmc_nadv_ale gpmc_noe GNF0 gpmc_nwe GNF3 gpmc_a[16:1] (gpmc_d[15:0])
Command
SWPS038-025
GNF6 GNF5
GNF4
(1)
In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.
GNF6
GNF8
GNF4
180
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com
GPMC_FCLK GNF12 GNF10 gpmc_ncsx gpmc_nbe0_cle gpmc_nadv_ale GNF14 gpmc_noe gpmc_a[16:1] (gpmc_d[15:0]) gpmc_waitx
SWPS038-027
GNF15
GNF13 DATA
(1)
(2) (3)
GNF12 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after GNF12 functional clock cycles, input data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. GNF12 value must be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally. In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7. In gpmc_waitx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, or 3.
gpmc_nbe0_cle
gpmc_nadv_ale
GNF4
(1)
In gpmc_ncsx, x is equal to 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
181
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.4.2
The SDRAM controller subsystem module provides connectivity between the processor and external DRAM memory components. The module includes support for double-data-rate SDRAM (mobile DDR). 6.4.2.1 LPDDR Interface
The LPDDR interface is balled out on the bottom side of the CUS package and on the top side of the POP packages. The LPDDR interface on the top of the POP package has been designed for compatibility any POP LPDDR device with a matching footprint and compliance with the JEDEC LPDDR-266 specification. This section provides the timing specification for the bottom-side LPDDR interface as a PCB design and manufacturing specification. The design rules constrain PCB trace length, PCB trace skew, signal integrity, cross-talk, and signal timing. These rules, when followed, result in a reliable LPDDR memory system without the need for a complex timing closure process. For more information regarding guidelines for using this LPDDR specification, see the Understanding TI's PCB Routing Rule-Based DDR Timing Specification Application Report (literature number SPRAAV0). 6.4.2.1.1 LPDDR Interface Schematic Figure 6-17 and Figure 6-18 show the LPDDR interface schematics for a LPDDR memory system. The 1 x16 LPDDR system schematic is identical to Figure 6-17 except that the high word LPDDR device is deleted.
182
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
LPDDR sdrc_d0 sdrc_d7 sdrc_dm0 sdrc_dqs0 sdrc_d8 sdrc_d15 sdrc_dm1 sdrc_dqs1 sdrc_d16 sdrc_d23 sdrc_dm2 sdrc_dqs2 sdrc_d24 sdrc_d31 sdrc_dm3 sdrc_dqs3 sdrc_ba0 sdrc_ba1 sdrc_a0 sdrc_a14 sdrc_ncs0 sdrc_ncs1 sdrc_ncas sdrc_nras sdrc_nwe sdrc_cke0 sdrc_cke1 sdrc_clk sdrc_nclk
T T
T T T T
T T T
LPDDR DQ0 DQ7 LDM LDQS DQ8 DQ15 UDM UDQS BA0 BA1 A0 A14 CS CAS RAS WE CKE CK CK
T T T T
T T T T T T
T T
N/C
T T T T
N/C
T T
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
183
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
LPDDR sdrc_d0 sdrc_d7 sdrc_dm0 sdrc_dqs0 sdrc_d8 sdrc_d15 sdrc_dm1 sdrc_dqs1 sdrc_d16 sdrc_d23 sdrc_dm2 sdrc_dqs2 sdrc_d24 sdrc_d31 sdrc_dm3 sdrc_dqs3 sdrc_ba0 sdrc_ba1 sdrc_a0 sdrc_a14 sdrc_ncs0 sdrc_ncs1 sdrc_ncas sdrc_nras sdrc_nwe sdrc_cke0 sdrc_cke1 sdrc_clk sdrc_nclk
T
DQ0 DQ7 DM0 DQS0 DQ8 DQ15 DM1 DQS1 DQ16 DQ23 DM2 DQS2 DQ24 DQ31 DM3 DQS3 BA0 BA1 A0 A14 CS
T T T T
T T T T
T T T T
T T T T T T
T T
N/C
T T T T
T T
Figure 6-18. DM37x LPDDR High Level Schematic (x32 memory) 6.4.2.1.2 Compatible JEDEC LPDDR Devices Table 6-13 shows the parameters of the JEDEC LPDDR devices that are compatible with this interface. Generally, the LPDDR interface is compatible with x16 and x32 LPDDR266 and LPDDR333 speed grade LPDDR devices. Table 6-13. Compatible JEDEC LPDDR Devices
NO. 1 2 3 4 PARAMETER JEDEC LPDDR Device Speed Grade JEDEC LPDDR Device Bit Width JEDEC LPDDR Device Count JEDEC LPDDR Device Ball Count MIN LPDDR-266 16 1 60 32 2 90 Bits Devices Balls See Note
(2)
MAX
UNIT
184
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) Higher LPDDR speed grades are supported due to inherent JEDEC LPDDR backwards compatibility. (2) 1 x16 LPDDR device is used for 16 bit LPDDR memory system. 1x32 or 2x16 LPDDR devices are used for a 32-bit LPDDR memory system.
6.4.2.1.3 PCB Stackup The minimum stackup required for routing the DM37x is a six layer stack as shown in Table 6-14. Additional layers may be added to the PCB stack up to accommodate other circuitry or to reduce the size of the PCB footprint. Table 6-14. DM37x Minimum PCB Stack Up
LAYER 1 2 3 4 5 6 TYPE Signal Plane Plane Signal Plane Signal DESCRIPTION Top Routing Mostly Horizontal Ground Power Internal Routing Ground Bottom Routing Mostly Vertical
(4)
TYP
MAX
UNIT
NOTES
0 4 4 18 8 Mils Mils Mils Mils See Note(1) See Note(2) 75 Z Z+5 See Note(3)
(1) See the Flip Chip Ball Grid Array Package (SPRU811) reference guide for device BGA pad size. (2) See the LPDDR device manufacturer documentation for the LPDDR device BGA pad size. (3) Z is the nominal singled ended impedance selected for the PCB specified by item 12. (4) Specific routing guidelines for the CUS package can be found in the AM37x CUS Routing Guidelines (SPRABD4) application note.
6.4.2.2
Placement
Figure 6-19 shows the required placement for the DM37x device as well as the LPDDR devices. The dimensions for Figure 6-19 are defined in Table 6-16. The placement does not restrict the side of the PCB that the devices are mounted on. The ultimate purpose of the placement is to limit the maximum trace lengths and allow for proper routing space. For 1x16 and 1x32 LPDDR memory systems, the second LPDDR device is omitted from the placement.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
185
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
LPDDR Controller
OMAP
Figure 6-19. DM37xx and LPDDR Device Placement Table 6-16. Placement Specifications
NO. 1 2 3 4 5 PARAMETER X Y Y Offset LPDDR Keepout Region Clearance from non-LPDDR signal to LPDDR Keepout Region 4 w MIN MAX 1440 1030 525 UNIT Mils Mils Mils NOTES See Notes(1), (2) See Notes(1), (2) See Notes(1),(2),(3) See Note(4) See Note(5)
(1) See Figure 6-17 for dimension definitions. (2) Measurements from center of device to center of LPDDR device. (3) For 16 bit memory systems it is recommended that Y Offset be as small as possible. (4) LPDDR keepout region to encompass entire LPDDR routing area. (5) Non-LPDDR signals allowed within LPDDR keepout region provided they are separated from LPDDR routing layers by a ground plane.
6.4.2.3
The region of the PCB used for the LPDDR circuitry must be isolated from other signals. The LPDDR keep out region is defined for this purpose and is shown in Figure 6-20. The size of this region varies with the placement and LPDDR routing. Additional clearances required for the keep out region are shown in Table 6-16.
186
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
A1
LPDDR Controller
LPDDR Device
A1
Region should encompass all LPDDR circuitry and varies depending on placement. Non-LPDDR signals should not be routed on the LPDDR signal layers within the LPDDR keep out region. Non-LPDDR signals may be routed in the region provided they are routed on layers separated from LPDDR signal layers by a ground layer. No breaks should be allowed in the reference ground layers in this region. In addition, the 1.8 V power plane should cover the entire keep out region.
Table 6-17 lists the clock net classes for the LPDDR interface. Table 6-18 lists the signal net classes, and associated clock net classes, for the signals in the LPDDR interface. These net classes are used for the termination and routing rules that follow. Table 6-17. Clock Net Class Definitions
CLOCK NET CLASS CK DQS0 DQS1 DQS2 DQS3 PIN NAMES sdrc_clk/sdrc_nclk sdrc_dqs0 sdrc_dqs1 sdrc_dqs2 sdrc_dqs3
6.4.2.5
No terminations of any kind are required in order to meet signal integrity and overshoot requirements. Serial terminators are permitted, if desired, to reduce EMI risk; however, serial terminations are the only type permitted. Table 6-19 shows the specifications for the series terminators.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
187
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) Only series termination is permitted, parallel or SST specifically disallowed. (2) Terminator values larger than typical only recommended to address EMI issues. (3) Termination value should be uniform across net class.
6.4.2.6
Figure 6-21 shows the topology of the routing for the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. The route is a balanced T as it is intended that the length of segments B and C be equal. In addition, the length of A should be maximized.
A1
T A C
LPDDR Controller
OMAP
A1
Figure 6-21. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing and Topology Table 6-20. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification
NO. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 PARAMETER Center to Center CK-CK spacing CK Differential Pair Skew Length Mismatch(4) CK B to C Skew Length Mismatch Center to Center CK to other LPDDR trace spacing CK/ADDR_CTRL nominal trace length ADDR_CTRL to CK Skew Length Mismatch ADDR_CTRL to ADDR_CTRL Skew Length Mismatch Center to Center ADDR_CTRL to other LPDDR trace spacing Center to Center ADDR_CTRL to other ADDR_CTRL trace spacing ADDR_CTRL A to B, ADDR_CTRL A to C Skew Length Mismatch ADDR_CTRL B to C Skew Length Mismatch 4w 3w 100 100 Mils Mils 4w CACLM-50 CACLM CACLM+50 100 100 Mils Mils Mils See Note(2) See Note(2) See Note(1) MIN TYP MAX 2w 25 25 Mils Mils See Note(2) See Note(3) See Note(1)
(5)
UNIT
NOTES
(1) Series terminator, if used, should be located closest to DM37x. (2) Center to center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum (w) for up to 500 mils of routed length to accommodate BGA escape and routing congestion. (3) CACLM is the longest Manhattan distance of the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. (4) Differential impedance should be 100 ohms. (5) Specific routing guidelines for the CUS package can be found in the AM37x CUS Routing Guidelines (SPRABD4) application note. 188 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Figure 6-22 shows the topology and routing for the DQS and DQ net classes; the routes are point to point. Skew matching across bytes is not needed nor recommended.
T A1 E0 T E1
LPDDR Controller
T A1 E2 T E3 OMAP
Figure 6-22. DQS and DQ Routing and Topology Table 6-21. DQS and DQ Routing Specification(1) (6)
PARAMETER DQS E Skew Length Mismatch Center to Center DQS to other LPDDR trace spacing DQS/DQ nominal trace length DQ to DQS Skew Length Mismatch DQ to DQ Skew Length Mismatch Center to Center DQ to other LPDDR trace spacing Center to Center DQ to other DQ trace spacing DQ E Skew Length Mismatch (1) Series terminator, if used, should be located closest to LPDDR. (2) Center to center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum (w) for up to 500 mils of routed length to accommodate BGA escape and routing congestion. (3) DQLM is the longest Manhattan distance of the DQS and DQ net classes. (4) There is no need, and it is not recommended, to skew match across data bytes. This specification is only relative within a data byte. (5) DQs from other bytes are considered other LPDDR traces. (6) Specific routing guidelines for the CUS package can be found in the AM37x CUS Routing Guidelines (SPRABD4) application note. 4w 3w 100 Mils 4w DQLM - 50 DQLM DQLM + 50 100 100 Mils Mils Mils MIN TYP MAX 25 UNIT Mils See Note(2) See Note(2) See Note See Note
(4) (4)
NOTES
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
189
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.5 6.5.1
The camera subsystem provides the system interfaces and the processing capability to connect raw, YUV or JPEG image sensor modules to the device for video-preview, video-record and still-image-capture applications. The camera ISP2P subsystem supports up to two simultaneous pixel flows but only one of them can use the video processing hardware: Parallel camera interface + Serial camera interface: one interface data goes through the video processing hardware. The other interface data goes directly to memory Serial camera interface + Serial camera interface: one serial interface data goes through the video processing hardware. The other serial interface data goes directly to memory. The camera ISP2P subsystem supports different camera configurations: 10-bit Parallel interface 12-bit Parallel interface 12-bit Parallel interface Note: For more information, see the Camera ISP / Camera ISP Environment / Camera ISP Connectivity Schemes section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). 6.5.1.1 Camera Output Clocks (cam_xclka and cam_xclkb) Table 6-22. ISP2P cam_xclka and cam_xclkb Output Clocks Switching Characteristics
NO. ISP15 ISP16 ISP16 1 / tc(xclk) tw(xclkH) tw(xclkL) tdc(xclk) tJ(xclk) tR(xclk) tF(xclk) PARAMETER MIN Frequency(1), output clock cam_xclkn(4) Typical pulse duration, output clock cam_xclkn(4) high Typical pulse duration, output clock cam_xclkn(4) low Duty cycle error, output clock cam_xclkn(4) Cycle jitter , output clock cam_xclkn Rise time, output clock cam_xclkn(4) Fall time, output clock cam_xclkn(4)
(4) (3) (4)
OPP100 MAX 216 0.5P(2) 0.5P(2) 0.5 * P(2) - 2.083 0.044 * P 0.93 0.93
(2)
OPP50 MIN MAX 216 0.5P(2) 0.5P(2) 0.5 * P(2) - 2.083 0.044 * P(2) 0.93 0.93
UNIT MHz ns ns ps ps ns ns
(1) Related with the cam_xclkn maximum and minimum frequencies programmable in the ISP module. NOTE: You must disable the camera sensor or the camera module to change the frequency configuration. For more information, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (2) P = cam_xclkn(4) period in ns (3) Maximum cycle jitter supported by cam_xclka and cam_xclkb output clocks. (4) In cam_xclkn, n is equal to a or b.
190
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
6.5.1.2
6.5.1.2.1 CPIVideo and Graphics Digitizer 1.8V Mode The imaging subsystem deals with the processing of the pixel data coming from an external image sensor or from video and graphics digitizer. It is a key component for the following multimedia applications: video preview, camera viewfinder, video record and still image capture. It supports RAW, RGB, and YUV data processing. Table 6-24 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-23 and Figure 6-24). Table 6-23. CPI Timing ConditionsVideo and Graphics Digitizer 1.8-V Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Input Conditions tR tF Input signal rise time Input signal fall time 80 80 1800 1800 ps ps VALUE MAX UNIT
Table 6-24. CPI Timing RequirementsVideo and Graphics Digitizer 1.8-V Mode(4) (6)
NO. ISP1 ISP2 ISP3 1 / tc(pclk) tw(pclkL) tw(pclkH) tdc(pclk) tJ(pclk) ISP4 ISP5 ISP6 ISP7 ISP8 ISP9 ISP10 ISP11 ISP12 ISP13 tsu(vsV-pclkH) th(pclkH-vsV) tsu(hsV-pclkH) th(pclkH-hsV) tsu(dV-pclkH) th(pclkH-dV) tsu(wenV-pclkH) th(pclkH-wenV) tsu(fldV-pclkH) th(pclkH-fldV) PARAMETER Frequency(1), input pixel clock cam_pclk Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk low Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk high Duty cycle error, input pixel clock cam_pclk Cycle jitter(3), input pixel clock cam_pclk Setup time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge Hold time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge Setup time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge Hold time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge Setup time, input data cam_d[n:0](5) valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge Hold time, input data cam_d[n:0](5) valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge Setup time, input write enable cam_wen valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge Hold time, input write enable cam_wen valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge Setup time, input field identification cam_fld valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge Hold time, input field identification cam_fld valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising/falling edge 0.75 0.96 0.75 0.96 0.75 0.96 0.75 0.96 0.75 0.96 0.5P
(2)
UNIT MHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
(1) Related with the input maximum frequency supported by the ISP module in 8-bit mode with 8 to 16 data bits conversion bridge enabled. (2) P = cam_pclk period in ns (3) Maximum cycle jitter supported by cam_pclk input clock (4) The timing requirements are assured up to the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified. (5) n = 11 (Data bus size is limited to 8 bits. So the bits configuration is either cam_d[7:0] or cam_d[11:4]). Lines not connected must be tied low. (6) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
191
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
ISP4 cam_vs
ISP5
ISP6 cam_hs
ISP7
ISP10 cam_wen
ISP11
cam_fld
SWPS038-048
(1)
(2)
The polarity of cam_pclk, cam_fld, cam_vs, and cam_hs are software configurable. Optionally, the cam_wen signal can be used as an external memory write-enable signal. For further details, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). N = 11 (Data bus size is limited to 8 bits. So the bits configuration is either cam_d[7:0] or cam_d[11:4]). When the number of data lines is less than cam_d[N:0], data lines can be connected to the upper or lower lines of cam_d[N:0]. Lines not connected must be tied low. For more information about video port mapping, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
192
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
ISP5
ISP7
ISP11
ODD
SWPS038-049
(1)
(2)
The polarity of cam_pclk, cam_fld, cam_vs, and cam_hs are software configurable. Optionally, the cam_wen signal can be used as an external memory write-enable signal. For further details, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). N = 11 (Data bus size is limited to 8 bits. So the bits configuration is either cam_d[7:0] or cam_d[11:4]). When the number of data lines is less than cam_d[N:0], data lines can be connected to the upper or lower lines of cam_d[N:0]. Lines not connected must be tied low. For more information about video port mapping, see the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
Figure 6-24. CPIVideo and Graphics Digitizer1.8-V Interlaced Mode 6.5.1.2.2 CPI12-Bit SYNC Normal Progressive Mode Table 6-26 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-25). Table 6-25. CPI Timing Conditions12-Bit SYNC Normal Progressive Mode(1)
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance 2.7 2.7 8.6 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
193
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 6-26. CPI Timing Requirements12-Bit SYNC Normal Progressive Mode(4) (5)
NO. ISP17 ISP18 ISP18 1 / tc(pclk) tw(pclkH) tw(pclkL) tdc(pclk) tJ(pclk) ISP19 ISP20 ISP21 ISP22 ISP23 ISP24 ISP25 ISP26 tsu(dV-pclkH) th(pclkH-dV) tsu(dV-vsH) th(pclkH-vsV) tsu(dV-hsH) th(pclkH-hsV) tsu(dV-hsH) th(pclkH-hsV) PARAMETER Frequency(1), input pixel clock cam_pclk Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk high Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk low Duty cycle error, input pixel clock cam_pclk Cycle jitter(3), input pixel clock cam_pclk Setup time, input data cam_d[11:0] valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input data cam_d[11:0] valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input write enable cam_wen valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input write enable cam_wen valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 0.5P(2) 0.5P
(2)
UNIT MHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
(1) Related with the input maximum frequency supported by the ISP module. (2) P = cam_pclk period in ns (3) Maximum cycle jitter supported by cam_pclk input clock. (4) The timing requirements are assured up to the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
194
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
ISP17 cam_pclk
ISP18
ISP18
ISP19 cam_vs
ISP20
ISP21 cam_hs
ISP22
ISP25 cam_wen
ISP26
cam_fld
SWPS038-050
The polarity of cam_pclk, cam_fld, cam_vs, and cam_hs are configurable. If the cam_hs, cam_vs, and cam_fld signals are output, the signal length can be set. The parallel camera in SYNC mode supports progressive image sensor modules and 8-, 10-, 11-, or 12-bit data. When the image sensor has fewer than 12 data lines, it must be connected to the lower data lines and the unused lines must be grounded. However, it is possible to shift the data to 0, 2, or 4 data internal lanes. The bit configurations are: cam_d[11:4] or cam_d[7:0] in 8-bit mode, cam_d[11:2] or cam_d[9:0] in 10-bit mode, cam_d[10:0] in 11-bit mode and cam_d[11:0] in 12-bit mode. Optionally, the data write to memory can be qualified by the external cam_wen signal. The cam_wen signal can be used as an external memory write-enable signal. The data is stored to memory only if cam_hs, cam_vs, and cam_wen signals are asserted. In cam_xclki, i can be equal to a or b. See Table 6-22 for ISP15 and ISP16 parameters.
Figure 6-25. CPI12-Bit SYNC Normal Progressive Mode 6.5.1.2.3 CPI8-Bit SYNC Packed Progressive Mode Table 6-28 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-26). Table 6-27. CPI Timing Conditions8-Bit SYNC Packed Progressive Mode(1)
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance 2.5 2.5 8.6 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Output Condition
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
195
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 6-28. CPI Timing Requirements8-Bit SYNC Packed Progressive Mode(4) (5)
NO. ISP3 ISP4 ISP4 1 / tc(pclk) tw(pclkH) tw(pclkL) tdc(pclk) tJ(pclk) ISP5 ISP6 ISP7 tsu(dV-pclkH) th(pclkH-dV) tsu(dV-vsH) PARAMETER MIN Frequency (1), input pixel clock cam_pclk Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk high Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk low Duty cycle error, input pixel clock cam_pclk Cycle jitter(3), input pixel clock cam_pclk Setup time, input data cam_d[7:0] valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input data cam_d[7:0] valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input write enable cam_wen valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input write enable cam_wen valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge 1.08 1.08 1.08 OPP100 MAX 130 0.5*P(2) 0.5*P(2) 0.5*P(2) 3.465 0.0649*P(2) 2.27 2.27 2.27 0.5*P(2) 0.5*P(2) 0.5*P(2) 6.93 0.0649*P(2) MIN OPP50 MAX 65 MHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
ISP8 ISP9
th(pclkH-vsV) tsu(dV-hsH)
1.08 1.08
2.27 2.27
ns ns
ISP10
th(pclkH-hsV)
1.08
2.27
ns
ISP11 ISP12
tsu(dV-hsH) th(pclkH-hsV)
1.08 1.08
2.27 2.27
ns ns
(1) Related with the input maximum frequency supported by the ISP module. (2) P = cam_pclk period in ns (3) Maximum cycle jitter supported by cam_pclk input clock. (4) The timing requirements are assured up to the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
196
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
ISP16 ISP15 cam_xclki ISP4 ISP3 cam_pclk ISP5 cam_vs ISP7 cam_hs ISP9 cam_d[7:0]
D(0) D(n-3) D(n-2) D(n-1) D(0)
ISP16
ISP4
ISP6
ISP8
ISP10
D(1) D(n-1)
ISP12
SWPS038-051
(4) (5)
The polarity of cam_pclk, cam_fld, cam_vs, and cam_hs are configurable. The image sensor is connected to the lower data lines and the unused lines are grounded. However, it is possible to shift the data to 0, 2, or 4 data internal lanes. The bit configurations are: cam_d[11:4] or cam_d[7:0] in 8-bit packed mode. Optionally, the data write to memory can be qualified by the external cam_wen signal. The cam_wen signal can be used as a external memory write-enable signal. The data is stored to memory only if cam_hs, cam_vs, and cam_wen signals are asserted. The polarity of cam_fld is programmable. The camera module can pack 8-bit data into 16 bits. It doubles the maximum pixel clock. This mode can be particularly useful to transfer an YCbCr data stream or compressed stream to memory at very high speed. In cam_xclki, i can be equal to a or b. See Table 6-22 for ISP15 and ISP16 parameters.
Figure 6-26. CPI8-Bit SYNC Packed Progressive Mode 6.5.1.2.4 CPI12-Bit SYNC Normal Interlaced Mode Table 6-30 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-27). Table 6-29. CPI Timing Conditions12-Bit SYNC Normal Interlaced Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 2.7 2.7 8.6 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
197
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 6-30. CPI Timing Requirements12-Bit SYNC Normal Interlaced Mode(4) (5)
NO. ISP17 ISP18 ISP18 1 / tc(pclk) tw(pclkH) tw(pclkL) tdc(pclk) tJ(pclk) ISP19 ISP20 ISP21 ISP22 ISP23 ISP24 ISP25 ISP26 ISP27 ISP28 tsu(dV-pclkH) th(pclkH-dV) tsu(dV-vsH) th(pclkH-vsV) tsu(dV-hsH) th(pclkH-hsV) tsu(dV-hsH) th(pclkH-hsV) tsu(dV-fldH) th(pclkH-fldV) PARAMETER Frequency(1), input pixel clock cam_pclk Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk high Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk low Duty cycle error, input pixel clock cam_pclk Cycle jitter(3), input pixel clock cam_pclk Setup time, input data cam_d[11:0] valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input data cam_d[11:0] valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input write enable cam_wen valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input write enable cam_wen valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input field identification cam_fld valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input field identification cam_fld valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 1.82 0.5P(2) 0.5P
(2)
UNIT MHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
3.25 3.25 3.25 3.25 3.25 3.25 3.25 3.25 3.25 3.25
(1) Related with the input maximum frequency supported by the ISP module. (2) P = cam_pclk period in ns (3) Maximum cycle jitter supported by cam_pclk input clock. (4) The timing requirements are assured up to the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
198
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
ISP20 ISP19 cam_vs FRAME(0) ISP21 cam_hs L(0) L(n-1) L(0) ISP23 cam_d[11:0]
D(0) D(n-3) D(n-2) D(n-1) D(0) D(1) D(2)
FRAME(0) ISP22
ISP24
D(n-1)
ISP25 cam_wen
ISP26
The polarity of cam_pclk, cam_fld, cam_vs, and cam_hs are configurable. If the cam_hs, cam_vs, and cam_fld signals are output, the signal length can be set. The parallel camera in SYNC mode supports interlaced image sensor modules and 8-, 10-, 11-, or 12-bit data. When the image sensor has fewer than 12 data lines, it is connected to the lower data lines and the unused lines are grounded. It is possible to shift the data to 0, 2, or 4 data internal lanes. The bit configurations are: cam_d[11:4] or cam_d[7:0] in 8-bit mode, cam_d[11:2] or cam_d[9:0] in 10-bit mode, cam_d[10:0] in 11-bit mode and cam_d[11:0] in 12-bit mode. Optionally, the data write to memory can be qualified by the external cam_wen signal. The cam_wen signal can be used as an external memory write-enable signal. The data is stored to memory only if cam_hs, cam_vs, and cam_wen signals are asserted. In cam_xclki, i can be equal to a or b. See Table 6-22 for ISP15 and ISP16 parameters.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
199
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.5.1.2.5 CPI8-Bit SYNC Packed Interlaced Mode Table 6-32 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-28). Table 6-31. CPI Timing Conditions8-Bit SYNC Packed Interlaced Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 2.5 2.5 8.6 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Table 6-32. CPI Timing Requirements8-Bit SYNC Packed Interlaced Mode(4) (5)
NO. ISP3 ISP4 ISP4 1 / tc(pclk) tw(pclkH) tw(pclkL) tdc(pclk) tJ(pclk) ISP5 ISP6 ISP7 ISP8 ISP9 ISP10 ISP11 ISP12 ISP13 ISP14 tsu(dV-pclkH) th(pclkH-dV) tsu(dV-vsH) th(pclkH-vsV) tsu(dV-hsH) th(pclkH-hsV) tsu(dV-hsH) th(pclkH-hsV) tsu(dV-fldH) th(pclkH-fldV) PARAMETER Frequency(1), input pixel clock cam_pclk Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk high Typical pulse duration, input pixel clock cam_pclk low Duty cycle error, input pixel clock cam_pclk Cycle jitter(3), input pixel clock cam_pclk Setup time, input data cam_d[8:0] valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input data cam_d[8:0] valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input vertical synchronization cam_vs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input horizontal synchronization cam_hs valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input write enable cam_wen valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input write enable cam_wen valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Setup time, input field identification cam_fld valid before input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge Hold time, input field identification cam_fld valid after input pixel clock cam_pclk rising edge 1.08 1.08 1.08 1.08 1.08 1.08 1.08 1.08 1.08 1.08 0.5P(2) 0.5P
(2)
UNIT MHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
2.27 2.27 2.27 2.27 2.27 2.27 2.27 2.27 2.27 2.27
(1) Related with the input maximum frequency supported by the ISP module. (2) P = cam_pclk period in ns (3) Maximum cycle jitter supported by cam_pclk input clock. (4) The timing requirements are assured up to the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
200
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
ISP15 cam_xclki
ISP16
ISP16
ISP4 ISP3 cam_pclk ISP6 cam_vs FRAME(0) ISP7 cam_hs L(0) L(n-1) L(0)
ISP9 ISP10
D(2) D(n-1)
ISP4
cam_d[7:0]
D(0)
D(n-3)
D(n-2)
D(n-1)
D(0)
D(1)
ISP12
SWPS038-053
The polarity of cam_pclk, cam_fld, cam_vs, and cam_hs are configurable. The image sensor is connected to the lower data lines and the unused lines are grounded. However, it is possible to shift the data to 0, 2, or 4 data internal lanes. The bit configurations are: cam_d[11:4] or cam_d[7:0] in 8-bit packed mode . Optionally, the data write to memory can be qualified by the external cam_wen signal. The cam_wen signal can be used as an external memory write-enable signal. The data is stored to memory only if cam_hs, cam_vs, and cam_wen signals are asserted. The camera module can pack 8-bit data into 16 bits. It doubles the maximum pixel clock. This mode can be particularly useful to transfer a YCbCr data stream or compressed stream to memory at very high speed. In cam_xclki, i can be equal to a or b. See Table 6-22 for ISP15 and ISP16 parameters.
Figure 6-28. CPI8-Bit SYNC Packed Interlaced Mode 6.5.1.2.6 CPIITU Mode Table 6-34 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-29). Table 6-33. CPI Timing ConditionsITU Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 2.7 2.7 8.6 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
201
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
UNIT MHz ns ns ns ns ns ns
3.25 3.25
(1) Related with the input maximum frequency supported by the ISP module. (2) P = cam_pclk period in ns (3) Maximum cycle jitter supported by cam_pclk input clock. (4) The timing requirements are assured up to the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
ISP16 ISP15 cam_xclki ISP16
ISP17 cam_pclk
ISP18
ISP18
(1)
(2) (3)
The unused lines are grounded and the data bus is connected to the lower data lines. However, it is possible to shift the data to 0, 2, or 4 data internal lanes. The different configurations are: cam_d[11:4] or cam_d[7:0] in 8-bit mode and cam_d[11:2] or cam_d[9:0] in 10-bit mode. The parallel camera in ITU mode supports progressive camera modules. In cam_xclki, i can be equal to a or b. See Table 6-22 for ISP15 and ISP16 parameters.
202
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
6.5.2
The display subsystem (DSS) provides the logic to display the video frame from external (SDRAM) or internal (SRAM) memory on an LCD panel or a TV set. The display subsystem integrates the following elements: Display controller (DISPC) module Remote frame buffer interface (RFBI) module NTSC/PAL video encoder LCD display with: Parallel Interface The two display supports can be active at the same time. 6.5.2.1 DSSParallel Interface
In parallel interface, the paths of the display subsystem modules are the display controller and the RFBI. The display controller has two I/O pad modes and could be in the following configuration: Bypass mode (RFBI disabled), which implements the MIPI DPI protocol RFBI mode (RFBI enabled), which implements MIPI DBI 2.0 type B protocol For more information about MIPI DPI and MIPI DBI protocols, see the DSS chapter in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). 6.5.2.1.1 DSSParallel InterfaceBypass Mode Two types of LCD panel are supported: Thin film transistor (TFT) or active matrix technology Supertwisted nematic (STN) or passive matrix technology Both configurations are discussed in the following paragraphs. 6.5.2.1.2 DSSParallel InterfaceBypass ModeTFT Mode Table 6-36 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-30). Table 6-35. DSS Timing ConditionsTFT Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 10 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 1 VALUE MAX UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
203
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
UNIT ns ns MHz ns
0.55P(1)
(5)
(1) P = dss_pclk period in ns (2) The pixel clock frequency is software programmable via the pixel clock divider configuration from 1 to 255 division range in the DISPC_DIVISOR register. (3) For the DSS (TFT mode) in HD-TV application, to run at full speed (74.3 MHz) it is recommended to use the dss_data[5:0] signals on the dss_data[23:18] balls (H26, H25, E28, J26, AC27, AC28). In that case, the dss_data[23:18] signals are available on the sys_boot0, sys_boot1, sys_boot3, sys_boot4, sys_boot5, and sys_boot6 balls (AH26, AG26, AF18, AF19, AE21, AF21) to run at full speed (74.3 MHz). If the dss_data[5:0] signals are used on the dss_data[5:0] balls (AG22, AH22, AG23, AH23, AG24, AH24), OPP100 DSS (TFT mode) are limited at 66 MHz. The values may change following the silicon characterization result. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks. (5) tW(pclk) = 0.66.P when DISPC_DIVISOR[6:0] PCD = 3.
DL4 dss_pclk
DL5
The pixel data bus depends on the use of 8-, 9-, 12-, 16-, 18-, or 24-bit per pixel data output pins. The pixel clock frequency is programmable. All timings not illustrated in the waveform are progammable by software, and control signal polarity and driven edge of dss_pclk too. For more information, see the DSS chapter in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
Figure 6-30. DSSTFT Mode 6.5.2.1.3 DSSParallel InterfaceBypass ModeSTN Mode Table 6-38 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-31). Table 6-37. DSS Timing ConditionsSTN Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 40 pF VALUE MAX UNIT
204
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(4)
UNIT ns MHz ns
(1) P = dss_pclk period in ns (2) The pixel clock frequency is software programmable via the pixel clock divider configuration from 1 to 255 division range in the DISPC_DIVISOR register. (3) The DSS in STN mode is used with 4 or 8 pins only; unused pixel data bits always remain low. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks. (5) tW(pclk) = 0.66P when DISPC_DIVISOR[6:0] PCD = 3.
DL5 DL4 dss_pclk
dss_vsync
dss_hsync
The pixel data bus depends on the use of 4-, 8-, 12-, 16-, 18-, or 24-bit per pixel data output pins. All timings not illustrated in the waveform are progammable by software, and control signal polarity and driven edge of dss_pclk too. dss_vsync width must be programmed to be as small as possible. The pixel clock frequency is programmable. For more information, see the DSS chapter in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
Figure 6-31. DSSSTN Mode 6.5.2.2 DSSParallel Interface RFBI Mode Applications
6.5.2.2.1 DSSParallel InterfaceRFBI Mode MIPI DBI-B 2.0 LCD Panel The Remote Frame Buffer Interface (RFBI) module provides the necessary control signals and data (MIPI DBI 2.0 type B protocol) to interface to the LCD driver of the LCD panel. Table 6-40 and Table 6-41 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-32 through Figure 6-34).
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
205
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 6-39. DSS Timing ConditionsRFBI ModeMIPI DBI 2.0 - LCD Panel(2)
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 15 15 30 ns ns pF VALUE MAX UNIT
Output Condition (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 1. (2) For any information regarding the RFBI registers configuration, see Display Subsystem / the Display Subsystem Environment / LCD Support / Parallel Interface / Parallel Interface in RFBI Mode (MIPI DBI Protocol) / Transaction Timing Diagrams section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
Table 6-40. DSS Timing RequirementsRFBI ModeMIPI DBI 2.0 - LCD Panel
NO. DR0 DR1 tsu(dV-rdH) th(rdH-dIV) td(Data
sampled)
PARAMETER Setup time, input data rfbi_da[15:0] valid to output read enable rfbi_rd high Hold time, output read enable rfbi_rd high to input data rfbi_da[15:0] invalid Input data rfbi_da[15:0] sampled at the end of the access time
UNIT ns ns
N(1)
ns
Table 6-41. DSS Switching Characteristics RFBI Mode MIPI DBI 2.0 - LCD Panel
PARAMETER tw(wrH) tw(wrL) td(a0-wrL) td(wrH-a0) td(csx-wrL) td(wrH-csxH) td(dV) td(a0H-rdL) td(rdlH-a0) tw(rdH) tw(rdL) td(rdL-csxL) td(rdH-csxH) tR(wr) tF(wr) tR(a0) tF(a0) tR(csx) 206 Pulse duration, output write enable rfbi_wr high Pulse duration, output write enable rfbi_wr low Delay time, output command/data control rfbi_a0 transition to output write enable rfbi_wr low Delay time, output write enable rfbi_wr high to output command/data control rfbi_a0 transition Delay time, output chip select rfbi_csx(14) low to output write enable rfbi_wr low Delay time, output write enable rfbi_wr high to output chip select rfbi_csx(14) high Output data rfbi_da[15:0] valid Delay time, output command/data control rfbi_a0 high to output read enable rfbi_rd low Delay time, output read enable rfbi_rd high to output command/data control rfbi_a0 transition Pulse duration, output read enable rfbi_rd high Pulse duration, output read enable rfbi_rd low Delay time, output read enable rfbi_rd low to output chip select rfbi_csx(14) low Delay time, output read enable rfbi_rd high to output chip select rfbi_csx(14) high Rise time, output write enable rfbi_wr Fall time, output write enable rfbi_wr Rise time, output command/data control rfbi_a0 Fall time, output command/data control rfbi_a0 Rise time, output chip select rfbi_csx
(14)
UNIT ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 10 10 10 10 10 ns ns ns ns ns
MAX
MAX
I(9) J(10) K
(11)
L(12) M(13)
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-41. DSS Switching Characteristics RFBI Mode MIPI DBI 2.0 - LCD Panel (continued)
PARAMETER tF(csx) tR(d) tF(d) tR(rd) tF(rd) Fall time, output chip select rfbi_csx(14) Rise time, output data rfbi_da[15:0] Fall time, output data rfbi_da[15:0] Rise time, output read enable rfbi_rd Fall time, output read enable rfbi_rd OPP100 MIN MAX 10 10 10 10 10 OPP50 MIN MAX 10 10 10 10 10 ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
(1) A = (WECycleTime WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (2) B = (WEOffTime WEOntime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (3) C = WEOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (4) D = (WECycleTime + CSPulseWidth WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK if mode Write to Read or Read to Write is enabled (5) E = (WEOnTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (6) F = (CSOffTime WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (7) G = WECycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (8) H = REOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (9) I = (RECycleTime + CSPulseWidth REOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK if mode Write to Read or Read to Write is enabled (10) J = (RECycleTime REOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (11) K = (REOffTime REOntime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (12) L = (REOnTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (13) M = (CSOffTime REOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (14) In rfbi_csx, x is equal to 0 or 1.
CsPulseWidth WeCycleTime rfbi_a0 CsOffTime CsOnTime rfbi_csx WeOffTime WeOnTime rfbi_wr rfbi_da[n:0] rfbi_rd rfbi_te_vsync[1:0] rfbi_hsync[1:0]
SWPS038-057
WeCycleTime
CsOffTime CsOnTime
WeOffTime WeOnTime
DATA0
DATA1
In rfbi_csx, x is equal to 0 or 1. rfbi_data[n:0], n up to 15 For more information, see the DSS chapter in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
Figure 6-32. DSSRFBI ModeMIPI DBI 2.0 LCD PanelCommand / Data Write
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
207
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
AccessTime ReCycleTime
rfbi_a0 CsOffTime CsOnTime rfbi_csx ReOffTime ReOnTime rfbi_rd DR0 rfbi_da[n:0] rfbi_wr rfbi_te_vsync[1:0] rfbi_hsync[1:0]
SWPS038-058
CsOffTime CsOnTime
ReOffTime ReOnTime
DR1 DATA1
DATA0
In rfbi_csx, x is equal to 0 or 1. rfbi_data[n:0], n up to 15 For more information, see the DSS chapter in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
Figure 6-33. DSSRFBI ModeMIPI DBI 2.0 LCD PanelCommand / Data Read
WECycleTime ReCycleTime AccessTime rfbi_a0 CsOffTime CsOnTime rfbi_csx WEOffTime WEOnTime rfbi_wr ReOffTime ReOnTime rfbi_rd CsPulseWidth rfbi_da[n:0] rfbi_te_vsync[1:0] rfbi_hsync[1:0]
SWPS038-059
WECycleTime
CsOffTime CsOnTime
CsOffTime CsOnTime
WEOffTime WEOnTime
CsPulseWidth WRITE
WRITE
READ
In rfbi_csx, x is equal to 0 or 1. rfbi_data[n:0], n up to 15 For more information, see the DSS chapter in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
Figure 6-34. DSSRFBI ModeMIPI DBI 2.0 LCD PanelCommand / Data Write to Read and Read to Write Modes
208
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
6.5.2.2.2 DSSParallel InterfaceRFBI ModePico DLP The Remote Frame Buffer Interface (RFBI) module can provide also the necessary control signals and data to interface to the Pico DLP driver of the Pico DLP panel. Table 6-42 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-35). Table 6-42. DSS Timing ConditionsRFBI ModePico DLP
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 5 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 0 VALUE MAX UNIT
To use Pico DLP application, RFBI register must be configured as shown in Table 6-43: Table 6-43. DSS Register ConfigurationRFBI ModePico DLP
DESCRIPTION Selection parallel mode Time Granularity (multiplies signal timing latencies by 2). CS signal assertion time from Start Access Time CS signal de-assertion time from Start Access Time WE signal assertion time from Start Access Time WE signal de-assertion time from Start Access Time RE signal assertion time from Start Access Time RE signal de-assertion time from Start Access Time Write cycle time Read cycle time CS pulse width Read to Write CS pulse width enable Read to Read CS pulse width enable Write to Write CS pulse width enable Write to Read CS pulse width enable From Start Access Time to CLK rising edge used for the first data capture REGISTER AND BIT FIELD(1) RFBI_CONFIGi and ParallelMode RFBI_CONFIGi andTimeGranularity RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi and CSOnTime RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi and CSOffTime RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi and WEOnTime RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi and WEOffTime RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi and REOnTime RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi and REOffTime RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi and WECycleTime RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi and ReCycleTime RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi and CSPulseWidth RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi and RWEnable RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi and RREnable RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi and WWEnable RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi and WREnable RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi and AccessTime BIT [1:0] [4] [3:0] [9:4] [13:10] [19:14] [23:20] [29:24] [5:0] [11:6] [17:12] [18] [19] [20] [21] [27:22] VALUES 0b11: 16-bit parallel output interface selected 0b0: x2 latency disable 0b0000 0b000100: 4 cycles 0b0000 0b000010: 2 cycles 0b0000 0b000000 0b000100: 4 cycles 0b000000 0b000000 0b0 0b0 0b0 0b0 0b000000
(1) i is equal to 0 or 1. For more information, see the DSS chapter in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4).
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
209
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
UNIT MAX ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
D(4) E(5) F(6) G(7) 15.5 H(8) I(9) J(10) K(11) L(12) M(13) 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 0
(19)
L(12) M(13)
Fall time, output chip select rfbi_csx(14) Rise time, output data rfbi_da[15:0](16) Fall time, output data rfbi_da[15:0]
(16)
Rise time, output read enable rfbi_rd Fall time, output read enable rfbi_rd CS signal assertion time from Start Access Time RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi Register CS signal de-assertion time from Start Access Time RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi Register WE signal assertion time from Start Access Time RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi Register WE signal de-assertion time from Start Access Time RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi Register RE signal assertion time from Start Access Time RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi Register RE signal de-assertion time from Start Access Time RFBI_ONOFF_TIMEi Register Write cycle time - RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi Register Read cycle time - RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi Register CS pulse width - RFBI_CYCLE_TIMEi Register
210
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) A = (WECycleTime WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (2) B = (WEOffTime WEOntime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (3) C = WEOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (4) D = (WECycleTime + CSPulseWidth WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK if mode Write to Read or Read to Write is enabled. (5) E = (WEOnTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (6) F = (CSOffTime WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (7) G = WECycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (8) H = REOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (9) I = (RECycleTime + CSPulseWidth REOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK if mode Write to Read or Read to Write is enabled. (10) J = (RECycleTime REOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (11) K = (REOffTime REOntime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (12) L = (REOnTime CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (13) M = (CSOffTime REOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * L4CLK (14) In rfbi_csx, x is equal to 0 or 1. (15) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks. (16) 16-bit parallel output interface is selected in DSS register. (17) At OPP100, L4 clock is 100 MHz and at OPP50, L4 clock is 50 MHz. (18) rfbi_wr must be at 25 MHz. (19) These values are calculated by the following formula: RFBI Register (Value) * L4 Clock (ns).
CsPulseWidth
WeCycleTime rfbi_a0 CsOffTime CsOnTime rfbi_csx WeOffTime WeOnTime rfbi_wr rfbi_da[n:0] rfbi_rd rfbi_te_vsync[1:0] rfbi_hsync[1:0] DATA0
WeCycleTime
CsOffTime CsOnTime
WeOffTime WeOnTime
DATA1
swps038-118
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
211
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.6 6.6.1
The Multichannel Buffered Serial Port (McBSP) provides a full duplex direct serial interface between the chip and other devices in a system such as other application chips, codecs. It can accommodate a wide range of peripherals and clocked frame oriented protocols (I2S, PCM, T ) due to its high level of versatility. McBSP may support two types of data transfer at the system level: The full cycle mode, for which one clock period is used to transfer the data, generated on one edge and captured on the same edge (one clock period later). The half cycle mode, for which one half clock period is used to transfer the data, generated on one edge and captured on the opposite edge (one half clock period later). Note that a new data is generated only every clock period, which secures the required hold time. The interface clock (clkx/clkr) activation edge (data/frame sync capture and generation) has to be configured accordingly with the external peripheral (activation edge capability) and the type of data transfer required at the system level. Depending on the number of pins, McBSP supports either: 6-pin mode: dx and dr as data pins; clkx, clkr, fsx, and fsr as control pins 4-pin mode: dx and dr as data pins; clkx and fsx pins as control pins. The clkx and fsx pins are internally looped back, via software configuration, respectively to the clkr and fsr internal signals for data receive. McBSP1 supports the 6-pin mode. McBSP2, 3, 4, and 5 support only the 4-pin mode. The following sections describe the timing characteristics for applications in normal mode (that is, McBSPx connected to one peripheral) and T applications in multipoint mode. 6.6.1.1 McBSP Timing ConditionsNormal Mode
Table 6-46 through Table 6-70 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-36 through Figure 6-43). Table 6-45. McBSP Timing ConditionsNormal Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 10 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: McBSP4 - Set #1: LB0 = 1. Otherwise: LB0 = 0. Input signal rise time Input signal fall time 2 2 ns ns VALUE UNIT
212
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
OPP50 MAX 24 24 16
48
24
48
24
48
16
MHz
32
16
32
16
MHz
Typical pulse duration, mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx high(2) Typical pulse duration, mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx low Duty cycle error, mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx(2) Jitter, mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx
(3)
ns ns ns ns
/ mcbsp_clks
(1) P = mcbspy_clkx(2) or mcbsp1_clkr output clock period in ns (2) In mcbspy, y is equal to 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5. (3) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
6.6.1.1.1 Rising Edge as Activation Mode 6.6.1.1.1.1 Timing with Rising Edge as Activation EdgeReceive Mode Table 6-47. McBSP1, 2, and 3 (Sets #2 and #3) Timing RequirementsRising Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B3 B4 B5 B6 tsu(DRV-CLKAE) th(CLKAE-DRV) tsu(FSV-CLKAE) th(CLKAE-FSV) PARAMETER Setup time, mcbspx_dr valid before mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge Hold time, mcbspx_dr valid after mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge Master Slave Master Slave OPP100 MIN 4.36 3.67 1.01 0.4 3.67 0.5 MAX OPP50 MIN 8.63 7.94 1.01 0.4 7.94 0.5 MAX ns ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
Setup time, mcbsp1_fsr / mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge Hold time, mcbsp1_fsr / mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
213
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 1, 2, or 3. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on UART pins) and Set #3 (multiplexing mode on McBSP1 pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-48. McBSP1, 2, and 3 (Sets #2 and #3) Switching CharacteristicsRising Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 td(CLKAE-FSV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbsp1_fsr / mcbspx_fsx valid OPP100 MIN 0.7 MAX 14.79 0.7 OPP50 MIN MAX 29.58 ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 1, 2, or 3. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on UART pins) and Set #3 (multiplexing mode on McBSP1 pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-49. McBSP4 (Set #1) Timing RequirementsRising Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B3 B4 B5 B6 tsu(DRV-CLKXAE) th(CLKXAE-DRV) PARAMETER Setup time, mcbspx_dr valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge Hold time, mcbspx_dr valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge Master Slave Master Slave OPP100 MIN 2.87 3.67 1.01 0.4 3.67 0.5 MAX OPP50 MIN 8.63 7.94 1.01 0.4 7.94 0.5 MAX ns ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 4. Note that for the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP4 is also multiplexed on GPMC pins (Set #2): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-51 and Table 6-52. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-50. McBSP4 (Set #1) Switching CharacteristicsRising Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid OPP100 MIN 0.7 MAX 16.56 0.7 OPP50 MIN MAX 33.12 ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 4. Note that for the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP4 is also multiplexed on GPMC pins (Set #2): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-51 and Table 6-52. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-51. McBSP3 (Set #1), 4 (Set #2), and 5 Timing RequirementsRising Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B3 B4 B5 B6 tsu(DRV-CLKXAE) th(CLKXAE-DRV) PARAMETER Setup time, mcbspx_dr valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge Hold time, mcbspx_dr valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge Master Slave Master Slave OPP100 MIN 6.49 5.80 1.01 0.4 5.81 0.5 MAX OPP50 MIN 12.90 12.21 1.01 0.4 12.21 0.5 MAX ns ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge
214
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 3, 4, or 5. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP3 is also multiplexed on UART pins (Set #2) and on McBSP1 pins (Set #3): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-47 and Table 6-48. For the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on GPMC pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-52. McBSP3 (Set #1), 4 (Set #2), and 5 Switching CharacteristicsRising Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid OPP100 MIN 0.7 MAX 22.18 0.7 OPP50 MIN MAX 44.37 ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 3, 4, or 5. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP3 is also multiplexed on UART pins (Set #2) and on McBSP1 pins (Set #3): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-47 and Table 6-48. For the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on GPMC pins) (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
B2
(1)
B6
(1)
Figure 6-37. McBSP Rising Edge Receive Timing in Slave Mode 6.6.1.1.1.2 Timing with Rising Edge as Activation EdgeTransmit Mode Table 6-53. McBSP1, 2, and 3 (Sets #2 and #3) Timing RequirementsRising Edge and Transmit Mode(1)
(2)
NO. B5 B6
PARAMETER tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge
UNIT ns ns
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
215
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 1, 2, or 3. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on UART pins) and Set #3 (multiplexing mode on McBSP1 pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-54. McBSP1, 2, and 3 (Sets #2 and #3) Switching CharacteristicsRising Edge and Transmit Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 B8 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) td(CLKXAE-DXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_dx valid Master Slave OPP100 MIN 0.7 0.6 0.6 MAX 14.79 14.79 13.89 0.7 0.6 0.6 OPP50 MIN MAX 29.58 29.58 28.68 ns ns ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 1, 2, or 3. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on UART pins) and Set #3 (multiplexing mode on McBSP1 pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-55. McBSP4 (Set #1) Timing RequirementsRising Edge and Transmit Mode(1) (2)
NO. B5 B6 PARAMETER tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge OPP100 MIN 3.67 0.5 MAX OPP50 MIN 7.94 0.5 MAX ns ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 4. Note that for the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP4 is also multiplexed on GPMC pins (Set #2): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-57 and Table 6-58. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-56. McBSP4 (Set #1) Switching CharacteristicsRising Edge and Transmit Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 B8 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) td(CLKXAE-DXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_dx valid Master Slave OPP100 MIN 0.7 0.6 0.6 MAX 16.56 16.56 17.15 0.7 0.6 0.6 OPP50 MIN MAX 33.12 33.12 32.22 ns ns ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 4. Note that for the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP4 is also multiplexed on GPMC pins (Set #2): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-57 and Table 6-58. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-57. McBSP3 (Set #1), 4 (Set #2), and 5 Timing RequirementsRising Edge and Transmit Mode(1)
(2)
NO. B5 B6
PARAMETER tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge
UNIT ns ns
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 3, 4, or 5. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP3 is also multiplexed on UART pins (Set #2) and on McBSP1 pins (Set #3): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-53 and Table 6-54. For the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on GPMC pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
216
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-58. McBSP3 (Set #1), 4 (Set #2), and 5 Switching CharacteristicsRising Edge and Transmit Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 B8 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) td(CLKXAE-DXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_dx valid Master Slave OPP100 MIN 0.7 0.6 0.6 MAX 22.18 21.28 21.28 0.7 0.6 0.6 OPP50 MIN MAX 44.37 43.47 43.47 ns ns ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 3, 4, or 5. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP3 is also multiplexed on UART pins (Set #2) and on McBSP1 pins (Set #3): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-53 and Table 6-54. For the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on GPMC pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
mcbspx_clkx B2 mcbspx_fsx B8 mcbspx_dx D7 D6 D5
SWPS038-064
B2
(1)
B6
(1)
Figure 6-39. McBSP Rising Edge Transmit Timing in Slave Mode 6.6.1.1.2 Falling Edge as Activation Edge 6.6.1.1.2.1 Timing with Falling Edge as Activation Edge ModeReceive Mode Table 6-59. McBSP1, 2, 3 (Sets #2 and #3) Timing RequirementsFalling Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B3 B4 B5 B6 tsu(DRV-CLKAE) th(CLKAE-DRV) tsu(FSV-CLKAE) th(CLKAE-FSV) PARAMETER Setup time, mcbspx_dr valid before mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge Hold time, mcbspx_dr valid after mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge Master Slave Master Slave OPP100 MIN 4.36 3.67 1.01 0.4 3.7 0.5 MAX OPP50 MIN 8.63 7.94 1.01 0.4 7.94 0.5 MAX ns ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
Setup time, mcbsp1_fsr / mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge Hold time, mcbsp1_fsr / mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
217
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 1, 2, or 3. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on UART pins) and Set #3 (multiplexing mode on McBSP1 pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-60. McBSP1, 2, and 3 (Sets #2 and #3) Switching CharacteristicsFalling Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 td(CLKAE-FSV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbsp1_clkr / mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbsp1_fsr / mcbspx_fsx valid OPP100 MIN 0.7 MAX 14.79 0.7 OPP50 MIN MAX 29.58 ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 1, 2, or 3. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on UART pins) and Set #3 (multiplexing mode on McBSP1 pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-61. McBSP4 (Set #1) Timing RequirementsFalling Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B3 B4 B5 B6 tsu(DRV-CLKXAE) th(CLKXAE-DRV) PARAMETER Setup time, mcbspx_dr valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge Hold time, mcbspx_dr valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge Master Slave Master Slave OPP100 MIN 2.87 3.67 1.01 0.4 3.67 0.5 MAX OPP50 MIN 8.63 7.94 1.01 0.4 7.94 0.5 MAX ns ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 4. Note that for the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP4 is also multiplexed on GPMC pins (Set #2): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-63 and Table 6-64. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-62. McBSP4 (Set #1) Switching CharacteristicsFalling Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid OPP100 MIN 0.7 MAX 16.56 0.7 OPP50 MIN MAX 33.12 ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 4. Note that for the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP4 is also multiplexed on GPMC pins (Set #2): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-63 and Table 6-64. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-63. McBSP3 (Set #1), 4 (Set #2), and 5 Timing RequirementsFalling Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B3 B4 B5 B6 tsu(DRV-CLKXAE) th(CLKXAE-DRV) PARAMETER Setup time, mcbspx_dr valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge Hold time, mcbspx_dr valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge Master Slave Master Slave OPP100 MIN 6.5 5.81 1.01 0.4 5.81 0.5 MAX OPP50 MIN 12.9 12.21 1.01 0.4 12.21 0.5 MAX ns ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge
218
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 3, 4, or 5. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP3 is also multiplexed on UART pins (Set #2) and on McBSP1 pins (Set #3): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-59 and Table 6-60. For the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on GPMC pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-64. McBSP3 (Set #1), 4 (Set #2), and 5 Switching CharacteristicsFalling Edge and Receive Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid OPP100 MIN 0.7 MAX 22.19 0.7 OPP50 MIN MAX 44.37 ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 3, 4, or 5. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP3 is also multiplexed on UART pins (Set #2) and on McBSP1 pins (Set #3): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-59 and Table 6-60. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
mcbspx_clkr B2 mcbspx_fsr B3 mcbspx_dr D7 B4 D6 D5
SWPS038-066
B2
(1)
B6
(1)
Figure 6-41. McBSP Falling Edge Receive Timing in Slave Mode 6.6.1.1.2.2 Timing with Falling Edge as Activation EdgeTransmit Mode Table 6-65. McBSP1, 2, and 3 (Sets #2 and #3) Timing RequirementsFalling Edge and Transmit Mode(1)(2)
NO. B5 B6 PARAMETER tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge OPP100 MIN 3.67 0.5 MAX OPP50 MIN 7.94 0.5 MAX ns ns UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
219
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 1, 2, or 3. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on UART pins) and Set #3 (multiplexing mode on McBSP1 pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-66. McBSP1, 2, and 3 (Sets #2 and #3) Switching CharacteristicsFalling Edge and Transmit Mode(1)(2)
NO. B2 B8 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) td(CLKXAE-DXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_dx valid Master Slave OPP100 MIN 0.7 0.6 0.6 MAX 14.79 14.79 13.89 0.7 0.6 0.6 OPP50 MIN MAX 29.58 29.58 28.68 ns ns ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 1, 2, or 3. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on UART pins) and Set #3 (multiplexing mode on McBSP1 pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-67. McBSP4 (Set #1) Timing RequirementsFalling Edge and Transmit Mode(1)(2)
NO. B5 B6 PARAMETER tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge OPP100 MIN 3.67 0.5 MAX OPP50 MIN 7.94 0.5 MAX ns ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 4. Note that for the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP4 is also multiplexed on GPMC pins (Set #2): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-69 and Table 6-70. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-68. McBSP4 (Set #1) Switching CharacteristicsFalling Edge and Transmit Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 B8 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) td(CLKXAE-DXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_dx valid Master Slave OPP100 MIN 0.7 0.6 0.6 MAX 16.56 16.56 17.15 0.7 0.6 0.6 OPP50 MIN MAX 33.12 33.12 32.22 ns ns ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 4. Note that for the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP4 is also multiplexed on GPMC pins (Set #2): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-69 and Table 6-70. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-69. McBSP3 (Set #1), 4 (Set #2), and 5 Timing RequirementsFalling Edge and Transmit Mode(1)
(2)
NO. B5 B6
PARAMETER tsu(FSXV-CLKXAE) Setup time, mcbspx_fsx valid before mcbspx_clkx active edge th(CLKXAE-FSXV) Hold time, mcbspx_fsx valid after mcbspx_clkx active edge
UNIT ns ns
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 3, 4, or 5. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP3 is also multiplexed on UART pins (Set #2) and on McBSP1 pins (Set #3): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-66 and Table 6-67. For the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on GPMC pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
220
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-70. McBSP3 (Set #1), 4 (Set #2), and 5 Switching CharacteristicsFalling Edge and Transmit Mode(1) (2)
NO. B2 B8 td(CLKXAE-FSXV) td(CLKXAE-DXV) PARAMETER Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_fsx valid Delay time, mcbspx_clkx active edge to mcbspx_dx valid Master Slave OPP100 MIN 0.7 0.6 0.6 MAX 22.18 21.28 21.28 0.7 0.6 0.6 OPP50 MIN MAX 44.37 43.47 43.47 ns ns ns UNIT
(1) In mcbspx, x identifies the McBSP number: 3, 4, or 5. Note that for the McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #1: multiplexing mode by default. The McBSP3 is also multiplexed on UART pins (Set #2) and on McBSP1 pins (Set #3): the corresponding timings are specified in Table 6-66 and Table 6-67. For the McBSP4, these timings concern only Set #2 (multiplexing mode on GPMC pins). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
mcbspx_clkx B2 mcbspx_fsx B8 mcbspx_dx D7 D6 D5
SWPS038-068
B2
(1)
B6
(1)
Figure 6-43. McBSP Falling Edge Transmit Timing in Slave Mode 6.6.1.2 McBSP in TDM Multipoint Mode (McBSP3)
For T application in multipoint mode, the processor is considered as a slave. Table 6-72 and Table 6-73 assume testing over the operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions described below. Table 6-71. McBSP3 (Set #3) Timing ConditionsT Multipoint Mode(1)
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(2) 1.0 1.0 8.5 8.5 40 ns ns pF VALUE MAX UNIT
Output Condition (1) For McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #3 (multiplexing mode in McBSP1 pins) (2) The load setting of the IO buffer: LB0 = 0.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 6-72. McBSP3 (Set #3) Timing RequirementsT Multipoint Mode(4) (continued)
NO. tw(clkxH) tw(clkxL) tdc(clkx) B3
(3)
PARAMETER Pulse duration, input clock mcbsp3_clkx high Pulse duration, input clock mcbsp3_clkx low Duty cycle error, input clock mcbsp3_clkx Setup time, input data mcbsp3_dr valid before input clock mcbsp3_clkx active edge Hold time, input data mcbsp3_dr valid after input clock mcbsp3_clkx active edge Setup time, input frame synchronization mcbsp3_fsx valid before input clock mcbsp3_clkx active edge Hold time, input frame synchronization mcbsp3_fsx valid after input clock mcbsp3_clkx active edge 9
UNIT ns ns
8.14
8.14
ns ns ns ns ns
2.4 9 2.4
(1) P = input clock mcbsp3_clkx period in ns (2) For McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #3 (multiplexing mode in McBSP1 pins). (3) See Section 6.6.1.1 for corresponding figures. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
(1) For McBSP3, these timings concern only Set #3 (multiplexing mode in McBSP1 pins). (2) See Section 6.6.1.1 for corresponding figures.
222
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
6.6.2
McSPI allows a duplex, synchronous, serial communication between a local host and SPI compliant external devices. The following timings are applicable to the different configurations of McSPI in master/slave mode for any McSPI and any channel (n). 6.6.2.1 McSPISlave Mode
In slave mode, McSPI initiates data transfer on the data lines (mcspix_somi, mcspix_simo) when it receives an SPI clock (mcspix_clk) from the external SPI master device. Table 6-75 and Table 6-76 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-44 and Figure 6-45). Table 6-74. McSPI Timing ConditionsSlave Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 20 pF (1) The load setting of the IO buffer: LB0 = 1. Input signal rise time Input signal fall time 4 4 ns ns VALUE UNIT
(3)
UNIT MHz ns ns ns ns ns
tsu(SIMOV-CLKAE) Setup time, mcspix_simo valid before mcspix_clk active edge th(SIMOV-CLKAE) tsu(CS0V-CLKFE) th(CS0I-CLKLE) Hold time, mcspix_simo valid after mcspix_clk active edge Setup time, mcspix_cs0 valid before mcspix_clk first edge Hold time, mcspix_cs0 invalid after mcspix_clk last edge
(1) In mcspix, x is equal to 1, 2, 3, or 4. (2) P = mcspix_clk clock period (3) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
223
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com (4)
UNIT ns ns
(1) In mcspix, x is equal to 1, 2, 3, or 4. (2) The polarity of mcspix_clk and the active edge (rising or falling) on which mcspix_simo is driven and mcspix_somi is latched is all software configurable: mcspix_clk(1) phase programmable with the bit PHA of MCSPI_CH(i)CONF register: PHA = 0 (Modes 0 and 2) For more information, see the McSPI environment chapter, Data Format Configurations section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4) for modes and phase correspondence description. (3) This timing applies to all configurations regardless of mcspix_clk polarity and which clock edges are used to drive output data and capture input data. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
PHA=0 EPOL=1 mcspi_cs(IN) SS1 SS0 SS4 mcspi_clk(IN) POL=0 SS1 SS0 POL=1 mcspi_clk(IN) SS7 mcspi_somi(OUT) PHA=1 EPOL=1 mcspi_cs(IN) SS1 SS0 SS4 mcspi_clk(IN) POL=0 SS1 SS0 POL=1 mcspi_clk(IN) SS6 mcspi_somi(OUT) Bit n1 SS6 Bit n2 SS6 Bit n3 SS6 Bit 1 Bit 0
SWPS038-070
SS1
SS5
SS1
SS6 Bit n2
Bit n1
SS1
SS5
SS1
(1) (2)
The active clock edge selection of mcspi_clk (rising or falling) on which mcspi_simo is driven and mcspi_somi data is latched is software configurable with the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[1] = POL and the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[0] = PHA. The polarity of mcspi_cs is software configurable with the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[6] = EPOL.
224
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com
PHA=0 EPOL=1 mcspi_cs(IN) SS1 SS0 SS4 mcspi_clk(IN) POL=0 SS1 SS0 POL=1 mcspi_clk(IN) SS1 SS1 SS5
PHA=1 EPOL=1 mcspi_cs(IN) SS1 SS0 SS4 mcspi_clk(IN) POL=0 SS1 SS0 POL=1 mcspi_clk(IN) SS1 SS1 SS5
SS2 SS3 SS2 mcspi_simo(IN) Bit n1 SS3 Bit n2 Bit n3 Bit 1 Bit 0 SWPS038-071
(1) (2)
The active clock edge selection of mcspi_clk (rising or falling) on which mcspi_simo is driven and mcspi_somi data is latched is software configurable with the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[1] = POL and the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[0] = PHA. The polarity of mcspi_cs is software configuable with the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[6] = EPOL.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
225
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.6.2.2
McSPIMaster Mode
In master mode, McSPI supports multichannel communication. McSPI initiates a data transfer on the data lines (SPIDAT [1:0]) and generates clock (SPICLK) and control signals (SPIEN) to a single SPI slave device at a time. Table 6-78 and Table 6-81 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-46 and Figure 6-47). Table 6-77. McSPI Timing ConditionsMaster Mode(1)
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Input Conditions tR tF Input signal rise time Input signal fall time 4 4 ns ns VALUE MAX UNIT
Output Conditions McSPI1, McSPI2, McSPI3, and McSPI4 CLOAD CLOAD CLOAD Output load capacitance for spix_csn signals Output load capacitance for spix_clk and spix_simo Output load capacitance for spix_clk and spix_simo 20 30 20 pF pF pF McSPI2 and McSPI3 McSPI1 and McSPI4 (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 1.
(1) In mcspix, x is equal to 1, 2, or 4. In mcspix_csn, n is equal to 0, 1, 2, or 3 for x equal to 1, n is equal to 0 or 1 for x equal to 2 and 4. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
UNIT 24 MHz
(3)
5.0
11.3
B(5) 3.2
(4)
4.4
226
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) In mcspix, x is equal to 1, 2, or 4. In mcspix_csn, n is equal to 0, 1, 2, or 3 for x equal to 1, n is equal to 0 or 1 for x equal to 2 and 4. (2) The polarity of mcspix_clk and the active edge (rising or falling) on which mcspix_simo is driven and mcspix_somi is latched is all software configurable: mcspix_clk(1) phase programmable with the bit PHA of MCSPI_CH(i)CONF register: PHA = 1 (Modes 1 and 3). mcspix_clk(1) phase programmable with the bit PHA of MCSPI_CH(i)CONF register: PHA = 0 (Modes 0 and 2). For more information, see the McSPI environment chapter, Data Format Configurations section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4) for modes and phase correspondence description. (3) P = mcspix_clk clock period (4) Case P = 20.8 ns, A = (TCS+0.5)*P(3) (TCS is a bit field of MSPI_CHCONFx[26:25] register). Case P > 20.8 ns, A = TCS*P(3) (TCS is a bitfield of MSPI_CHCONFx[26:25] register). For more information, see the McSPI chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (5) B = TCS*P(3) (TCS is a bit field of MSPI_CHCONFx[26:25] register). For more information, see the McSPI chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (6) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
(2) (6)
UNIT 12 MHz
(3)
4.31 6.77
4.30 6.71 ns
4.0 11.3 5.3 A(4) 10.1 B(5) 10.1 B(5) 10.1 A(4) 10.1
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
227
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
(1) In mcspi3_csn, n is equal to 0 or 1. The polarity of mcspi3_clk and the active edge (rising or falling) on which mcspi3_simo is driven and mcspi3_somi is latched is all software configurable. mcspi3_clk phase programmable with the bit PHA of MCSPI_CH(i)CONF register: PHA = 1 (Modes 1 and 3). mcspi3_clk phase programmable with the bit PHA of MCSPI_CH(i)CONF register: PHA = 0 (Modes 0 and 2). For more information, see the McSPI environment chapter, Data Format Configurations section of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4) for modes and phase correspondence description. (2) This timing applies to all configurations regardless of McSPI3_CLK polarity and which clock edges are used to drive output data and capture input data. (3) P = mcspi3_clk clock period (4) Case P = 20.8 ns, A = (TCS + 0.5)*P(3) (TCS is a bit field of MSPI_CHCONFx[26:25] register). Case P > 20.8 ns, A = TCS*P(3) (TCS is a bit field of MSPI_CHCONFx[26:25] register). For more information, see the McSPI chapter of AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (5) B = TCS*P(3) (TCS is a bit field of MSPI_CHCONFx[26:25] register). For more information, see the McSPI chapter of AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (6) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
PHA=0 EPOL=1 mcspi_cs(OUT) SM0 SM1 SM5 mcspi_clk(OUT) POL=0 SM1 SM0 POL=1 mcspi_clk(OUT) SM1 SM1 SM6
SM4 Bit n2
PHA=1 EPOL=1 mcspi_cs(OUT) SM1 SM0 SM5 mcspi_clk(OUT) POL=0 SM0 SM1 POL=1 mcspi_clk(OUT) SM1 SM1 SM6
SM4 Bit n2
SM4 Bit n3
(1) (2)
The active clock edge selection of mcspi_clk (rising or falling) on which mcspi_simo is driven and mcspi_somi data is latched is software configurable with the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[1] = POL and the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[0] = PHA. The polarity of mcspi_ncs is software configuable with the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[6] = EPOL.
228
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com
PHA=0 EPOL=1 mcspi_cs(OUT) SM0 SM1 SM5 mcspi_clk(OUT) POL=0 SM1 SM6
SM1 SM0 POL=1 mcspi_clk(OUT) SM2 SM3 mcspi_somi(IN) Bit n1 SM2 SM3 Bit n2 Bit n3 Bit n-4 Bit 0 SM1
PHA=1 EPOL=1 mcspi_cs(OUT) SM1 SM0 SM5 mcspi_clk(OUT) POL=0 SM0 SM1 POL=1 mcspi_clk(OUT) SM2 SM3 mcspi_somi(IN) Bit n1 SM2 SM3 Bit n2 Bit n3 Bit 1 Bit 0
SWPS038-073
SM1
SM6
SM1
(1) (2)
The active clock edge selection of mcspi_clk (rising or falling) on which mcspi_simo is driven and mcspi_somi data is latched is software configurable with the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[1] = POL and the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[0] = PHA. The polarity of mcspi_ncs is software configuable with the bit MCSPI_CH(i)CONF[6] = EPOL.
6.6.3
The processor provides three USB ports working in full- and low-speed data transactions (up to 12Mbit/s). When connected to either a serial link controller or a serial PHY (PHY interface modes) it supports: 6-pin (Tx: Dat/Se0 or Tx: Dp/ ) unidirectional mode 4-pin bidirectional mode 3-pin bidirectional
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
229
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.6.3.1
Table 6-83 and Table 6-84 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-48). Table 6-82. LS- / FS-USB Timing ConditionsUnidirectional Standard 6-Pin Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 15 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 1. Input signal rise time Input signal fall time 2 2 ns ns VALUE UNIT
Table 6-83. LS- / FS-USB Timing RequirementsUnidirectional Standard 6-Pin Mode(1) (2)
NO. FSU1 FSU2 FSU3 FSU4 td(vp,vm) td(vp,vm) td(rcvU0) td(rcvU1) PARAMETER Time duration, mmx_rxdp and mmx_rx low together during transition Time duration, mmx_rxdp and mmx_rx high together during transition Time duration, mmx_rrxcv undefine during a single end 0 (mmx_rxdp and mmx_rx low together) Time duration, mmx_rxrcv undefine during a single end 1 (mmx_rxdp and mmx_rx high together) OPP100 MIN MAX 14 8 14 8 OPP50 MIN MAX 14 8 14 8 ns ns ns ns UNIT
Table 6-84. LS- / FS-USB Switching CharacteristicsUnidirectional Standard 6-Pin Mode(1) (2)
NO. FSU5 FSU6 FSU7 FSU8 FSU9 td(txenL-dV) td(txenL-se0V) ts(d-se0) td(dI-txenH) td(se0I-txenH) PARAMETER Delay time, mmx_txen_n low to mmx_txdat valid Delay time, mmx_txen_n low to mmx_txse0 valid Skew between mmx_txdat and mmx_txse0 transition Delay time, mmx_txdat invalid to mmx_txen_n high Delay time, mmx_txse0 invalid to mmx_txen_n high 81.8 81.8 OPP100 MIN 81.8 81.8 MAX 84.8 84.8 1.5 81.8 81.8 OPP50 MIN 81.8 81.8 MAX 84.8 84.8 1.5 ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
230
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Receive
(1)
In mmx, x is equal to 0, 1, or 2.
Figure 6-48. LS- / FS-USBUnidirectional Standard 6-Pin Mode 6.6.3.2 FS-USBBidirectional Standard 4-pin Mode
Table 6-86 and Table 6-87 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-49). Table 6-85. LS- / FS-USB Timing ConditionsBidirectional Standard 4-Pin Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 15 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 1. Input signal rise time Input signal fall time 2 2 ns ns VALUE UNIT
Table 6-86. LS- / FS-USB Timing RequirementsBidirectional Standard 4-Pin Mode(1) (2)
NO. FSU10 FSU11 FSU12 FSU13 td(d,se0) td(d,se0) td(rcvU0) td(rcvU1) PARAMETER Time duration, mmx_txdat and mmx_txse0 low together during transition Time duration, mmx_txdat and mmx_txse0 high together during transition Time duration, mmx_rrxcv undefine during a single end 0 (mmx_txdat and mmx_txse0 low together) Time duration, mmx_rxrcv undefine during a single end 1 (mmx_txdat and mmx_txse0 high together) OPP100 MIN MAX 14 8 14 8 OPP50 MIN MAX 14 8 14 8 ns ns ns ns UNIT
Table 6-87. LS- / FS-USB Switching CharacteristicsBidirectional Standard 4-Pin Mode(1) (2)
NO. FSU14 FSU15 FSU16 FSU17 td(txenL-dV) td(txenL-se0V) ts(d-se0) td(dV-txenH) PARAMETER Delay time, mmx_txen_n low to mmx_txdat valid Delay time, mmx_txen_n low to mmx_txse0 valid Skew between mmx_txdat and mmx_txse0 transition Delay time, mmx_txdat invalid before mmx_txen_n high 81.8 OPP100 MIN 81.8 81.8 MAX 84.8 84.8 1.5 81.8 OPP50 MIN 81.8 81.8 MAX 84.8 84.8 1.5 ns ns ns ns UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
231
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 6-87. LS- / FS-USB Switching CharacteristicsBidirectional Standard 4-Pin Mode(1) (2) (continued)
NO. FSU18 td(se0V-txenH) PARAMETER Delay time, mmx_txse0 invalid before mmx_txen_n high OPP100 MIN 81.8 MAX OPP50 MIN 81.8 MAX ns UNIT
Transmit FSU17
FSU16
FSU18
FSU10
FSU11
FSU12 mmx_rxrcv
FSU13
SWPS038-075
(1)
In mmx, x is equal to 0, 1, or 2.
Figure 6-49. LS- / FS-USBBidirectional Standard 4-Pin Mode 6.6.3.3 FS-USBBidirectional Standard 3-pin Mode
Table 6-89 and Table 6-90 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-50). Table 6-88. LS- / FS-USB Timing ConditionsBidirectional Standard 3-Pin Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 15 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 1. Input signal rise time Input signal fall time 2 2 ns ns VALUE UNIT
Table 6-89. LS- / FS-USB Timing RequirementsBidirectional Standard 3-Pin Mode(1) (2)
NO. FSU19 FSU20 td(d,se0) td(d,se0) PARAMETER Time duration, mmx_txdat and mmx_txse0 low together during transition Time duration, mmx_tsdat and mmx_txse0 high together during transition OPP100 MIN MAX 14 8 OPP50 MIN MAX 14 8 ns ns UNIT
232
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-90. LS- / FS-USB Switching CharacteristicsBidirectional Standard 3-Pin Mode(1) (2)
NO. FSU21 FSU22 FSU23 FSU24 FSU25 td(txenL-dV) td(txenL-se0V) ts(d-se0) td(dI-txenH) td(se0I-txenH) PARAMETER Delay time, mmx_txen_n low to mmx_txdat valid Delay time, mmx_txen_n low to mmx_txse0 valid Skew between mmx_txdat and mmx_txse0 transition Delay time, mmx_txdat invalid to mmx_txen_n high Delay time, mmx_txse0 invalid to mmx_txen_n high 81.8 81.8 OPP100 MIN 81.8 81.8 MAX 84.8 84.8 1.5 81.8 81.8 OPP50 MIN 81.8 81.8 MAX 84.8 84.8 1.5 ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
Transmit FSU24
FSU23
FSU25
FSU19
FSU20
SWPS038-076
(1)
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
233
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.6.4
In addition to the full-speed (FS) USB controller, a high-speed (HS) USB OTG controller is incorporated in the device. It allows high-speed transactions (up to 480 Mbit/s) on the USB ports 0, 1, 2, and 3 described below: Port 0: 12-bit slave mode (SDR) Ports 1 and 2: 12-bit master mode (SDR) Port 3: 6.6.4.1 HSUSB0Port 012-bit Slave Mode
Table 6-92 and Table 6-93 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-51). Table 6-91. HSUSB0 Timing Conditions12-bit Slave Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 3.5 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 0. Input signal rise time Input signal fall time 2 2 ns ns VALUE UNIT
UNIT MHz ps ns ns ns ns ns ns
(1) Related with the input maximum frequency supported by the USB module. (2) Maximum cycle jitter supported by hsusb0_clk input clock (3) The timing requirements are assured up to the cycle jitter error condition specified. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
234
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
hsusb0_clk HSU1 hsusb0_stp HSU3 hsusb0_dir and hsusb0_nxt HSU5 HSU2 hsusb0_data[7:0] Data_OUT HSU2 Data_IN
SWPS038-080
HSU1
HSU4
HSU6
Figure 6-51. HSUSB012-bit Slave Mode 6.6.4.2 HSUSB1 and HSUSB2Ports 1 and 212-bit Slave Mode
Table 6-95 and Table 6-96 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-52). Table 6-94. HSUSB1 and HSUSB2 Timing Conditions12-bit Master Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 5 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 0. Input signal rise time Input signal fall time 3 2 ns ns VALUE UNIT
(2)
UNIT ns ns ns ns ns
MAX
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
235
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com (2)
(continued)
UNIT ns MAX
OPP100
(3)
UNIT MHz ps ns ns
12.81
ns ns ns ns
(1) In hsusbx, x is equal to 1 or 2. (2) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (3) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
HSU0
hsusbx_clk HSU1 hsusbx_stp HSU3 hsusbx_dir and hsusbx_nxt HSU5 HSU2 hsusbx_data[7:0] Data_OUT HSU2 Data_IN
SWPS038-081
HSU1
HSU4
HSU6
(1)
In hsusbx, x is equal to 1 or 2.
6.6.5
The multi-master I2C peripheral provides an interface between two or more devices via an I2C serial bus.
236
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
The I2C controller supports the multi-master mode which allows more than one device capable of controlling the bus to be connected to it. Each I2C device is recognized by a unique address and can operates as either transmitter or receiver, according to the function of the device. In addition to being a transmitter or receiver, a device connected to the I2C bus can also be considered as master or slave when performing data transfers. This data transfer is carried out via two serial bidirectional wires: An SDA data line An SCL clock line In Figure 6-53 the data transfer is in master or slave configuration with 7-bit addressing format. The I2C interface is compliant with Philips I2C specification version 2.1. It supports standard mode (up to 100K bits/s), fast mode (up to 400K bits/s) and high-speed mode (up to 3.4Mb/s). 6.6.5.1 I2CStandard and Fast Modes Table 6-97. I2CStandard and Fast Modes
NO. fscl I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 tw(sclH) tw(sclL) tsu(sdaV-sclH) th(sclH-sdaV) tsu(sdaL-sclH) PARAMETER Frequency, clock i2cx_scl(4) Pulse duration, clock i2cx_scl(4) high Pulse duration, clock i2cx_scl(4) low Setup time, data i2cx_sda i2cx_scl(4) active level
(4)
STANDARD MODE MIN 4.0 4.7 250 0(2) 4.7 3.45(3) MAX 100
UNIT kHz s s ns
MAX 400
Hold time, data i2cx_sda(4) valid after clock i2cx_scl(4) active level Setup time, clock i2cx_scl(4) high after data i2cx_sda(4) low (for a START(5) condition or a repeated START condition) Hold time, data i2cx_sda low level after clock i2cx_scl(4) high level (STOP condition) Hold time, data i2cx_sda(4) low level after clock i2cx_scl(4) high level (for a repeated START condition) Pulse duration, data i2cx_sda(4) high between STOP and START conditions Rise time, clock i2cx_scl(4) Fall time, clock i2cx_scl(4) Rise time, data i2cx_sda(4) Fall time, data i2cx_sda(4) Capacitive load for each bus line
0(2) 0.6
0.9(3)
s s
I6 I7
th(sclH-sdaH) th(sclH-RSTART)
4.0 4.0
0.6 0.6
s s
I8
1.3 20 + 0.1CB 20 + 0.1CB 20 + 0.1CB 20 + 0.1CB 300 300 300 300 400
s ns ns ns ns pF
(1) A fast-mode I2C-bus device can be used in a standard-mode I2C-bus system, but the requirement tsu(SDAV-SCLH) 250 ns must then be met. This is automatically the case if the device does not stretch the low period of the i2cx_scl(4). If such a device does stretch the low period of the i2cx_scl(4), it must output the next data bit to the i2cx_sda(4) line tr(SDA) max + tsu(SDAV-SCLH) = 1000 + 250 = 1250 ns (according to the standard-mode I2C-bus specification) before the i2cx_scl(4) line is released. (2) The device provides (via the I2C bus) a minimum hold time (= I2C_FCLK period x (PSC+1) x 4) for the i2cx_sda(4) signal (see the fall and rise times of i2cx_scl(4)) to bridge the undefined region of the falling edge of i2cx_scl(4). (3) The maximum th(SCLH-SDA) has only to be met if the device does not stretch the low period of the i2cx_scl(4) signal. (4) In i2cx, x is equal to 1, 2, 3, or 4. Note that I2C4 is master transmitter only. (5) After this time, the first clock is generated.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
237
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
START
START
i2cX_sda I5 I6 i2cX_scl
SWPS038-084
I8 I7
I1
I2
I3
I4
I6
(1)
In i2cX, X is equal to 1, 2, 3, or 4.
Figure 6-53. I2CStandard and Fast Modes 6.6.5.2 I2CHigh-Speed Mode Table 6-98. I2CHigh-Speed Mode
NO. fscl I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 tw(sclH) tw(sclL) tsu(sdaV-sclH) th(sclH-sdaV) tsu(sdaL-sclH) th(sclH-sdaH) th(sclH-RSTART) tR(scl) tR(scl) tF(scl) tR(sda) tF(sda) CB PARAMETER Frequency, clock i2cx_scl(3) Pulse duration, clock i2cx_scl
(3)
MIN 60
(1)
MAX 3.4(5)
UNIT MHz ns ns ns
high
Pulse duration, clock i2cx_scl(3) low Setup time, data i2cx_sda(3) valid before clock i2cx_scl(3) active level Hold time, data i2cx_sda
(3)
160(1) 10 0
(4) (3)
active level
70
ns ns ns ns
Setup time, clock i2cx_scl(3) high after data i2cx_sda(3) low (for a START(2) condition or a repeated START condition) Hold time, data i2cx_sda(3) low level after clock i2cx_scl(3) high level (STOP condition) Hold time, data i2cx_sda(3) low level after clock i2cx_scl(3) high level (for a repeated START condition) Rise time, clock i2cx_scl(3) Rise time, clock i2cx_scl(3) after a repeated START condition and after a bit acknowledge Fall time, clock i2cx_scl(3) Rise time, data i2cx_sda
(3)
ns ns ns ns ns pF
Fall time, data i2cx_sda(3) Capacitive load for each bus line
(1) HS-mode master devices generate a serial clock signal with a high to low ratio of 1 to 2. tw(sclL) > 2 * tw(sclH). (2) After this time, the first clock is generated. (3) In i2cx, x is equal to 1, 2, 3, or 4. Note that I2C4 is master transmitter only. (4) The device provides (via the I2C bus) a minimum hold time (= I2C_FCLK period x 4) for the i2cx_sda(3) signal (see the fall and rise times of i2cx_scl(3)) to bridge the undefined region of the falling edge of i2cx_scl(3). (5) The I2C4 clock frequency in high-speed mode is equal to the sys_xtalin input clock frequency divided by 15.
START REPEAT i2cX_sda IH5 i2cX_scl
SWPS038-085
STOP
IH6
IH1
IH2
IH3
IH4
IH7
(1)
In i2cX, X is equal to 1, 2, 3, or 4.
238
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
6.6.6
The module is intended to work with both HDQ and 1-Wire protocols. The protocols use a single wire to communicate between the master and the slave. The protocols employ an asynchronous return to one mechanism where, after any command, the line is pulled high. 6.6.6.1 HDQ/1-WireHDQ Mode
Table 6-100 and Table 6-102 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-55 through Figure 6-59). Table 6-100. HDQ Interface Read Timing
PARAMETER tCYCH tHW1 tHW0 tRSPS (1) Defined by software (2) If the HDQ slave device drives a logic-low state after tHW0 max, it can be interpreted as a break pulse. For more information see Table 6-101 and the HDQ/1-Wire chapter of the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). DESCRIPTION Read bit window timing Read one data valid after HDQ low Read zero data hold after HDQ low Response time from HDQ slave device(1) MIN 190 32(2) 70
(2)
TYP
UNIT s s s s
190
320
(1) The different cases can be interpreted as follows: Case 1: If a logic-low state is present at the first sampling time and also at the second sampling time, the receive data can be interpreted as a break pulse. Case 2: If a logic-low state is present at the first sampling time and a logic-high state is present at the second sampling time, the receive data on the line is a zero (data). Case 3: Undefined. Case 4: If a logic-high state is present at the first sampling time and also at the second sampling time, the receive data on the line is a one (data).
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
239
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
tB HDQ
tBR
SWPS038-086
Figure 6-55. HDQ Break and Break Recovery Timing HDQ Interface Writing to Slave
tB HDQ tHW1 tHW0
SWPS038-122
tBR
Data_byte_received tRSPS 1
7_(MSB)
0_(LSB)
Table 6-103 and Table 6-104 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-60 through Figure 6-63).
240
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
DESCRIPTION
TYP
UNIT s s s s s s s
(1) tLOWR (low pulse sent by the master) must be short as possible to maximize the master sampling window. (2) tLOW0 must be less than tSLOT.
tRSTH 1-WIRE tRTSL tPDH tPDL
SWPS038-090
SWPS038-091
SWPS038-123
SWPS038-124
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
241
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.6.7
6.6.7.1
tR, Rise time tF, Fall time CL, Output load tR, Rise time tF, Fall time CL, Output load tR, Rise time tF, Fall time CL, Output load
Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART2) UART2 (uart2_tx): AA25 0 tR, Rise time tF, Fall time CL, Output load UART2 (uart2_rts): AB25 0 tR, Rise time tF, Fall time CL, Output load UART2 (uart2_tx): AF5 1 tR, Rise time tF, Fall time CL, Output load UART2 (uart2_rts): AE6 1 tR, Rise time tF, Fall time CL, Output load UART2 (uart2_tx): T27 5 tR, Rise time tF, Fall time CL, Output load UART2 (uart2_rts): U27 5 tR, Rise time tF, Fall time CL, Output load Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART3)
242
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
MIN 1 4
MAX 15 60 5 21 7 33 15 60 5 21 7 33 15 60 5 21 7
UNIT ns pF ns pF ns pF ns pF ns pF ns pF ns pF ns pF ns
0.4 2
0.6 7
1 4
0.4 2
0.6 7
1 4
SC0, SC1 = 00
(1)
0.4 2 0.6
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
243
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.6.7.2
UART3 IrDA
The IrDA module can operate in three different modes: Slow infrared (SIR) ( 115.2 Kbits/s) Medium infrared (MIR) (0.576 Mbits/s and 1.152 Mbits/s) Fast infrared (FIR) (4 Mbits/s)
Pulse Duration
90%
90%
50%
50%
10% tr tf
10%
SWPS038-093
Figure 6-64. UART IrDA Pulse Parameters 6.6.7.2.1 UART3 IrDAReceive Mode Table 6-106. UART3 IrDA Signaling Rate and Pulse DurationReceive Mode
SIGNALING RATE SIR 2.4 Kbit/s 9.6 Kbit/s 19.2 Kbit/s 38.4 Kbit/s 57.6 Kbit/s 115.2 Kbit/s MIR 0.576 Mbit/s 244 300.55 416.67 867.86 ns 52.17 13.10 6.59 3.34 2.25 1.17 78.13 19.53 9.77 4.88 3.26 1.63 208.33 52.08 26.04 13.02 8.68 4.34 s s s s s s ELECTRICAL PULSE DURATION MIN TYP MAX UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-106. UART3 IrDA Signaling Rate and Pulse DurationReceive Mode (continued)
SIGNALING RATE 1.152 Mbit/s FIR 4.0 Mbit/s (Single pulse) 4.0 Mbit/s (Double pulse) 62.70 208.53 125.00 250.00 170.63 291.47 ns ns ELECTRICAL PULSE DURATION MIN 192.04 TYP 208.33 MAX 433.83 ns UNIT
6.6.7.2.2 UART3 IrDATransmit Mode Table 6-108. UART3 IrDA Signaling Rate and Pulse DurationTransmit Mode
SIGNALING RATE SIR 2.4 Kbit/s 9.6 Kbit/s 19.2 Kbit/s 38.4 Kbit/s 57.6 Kbit/s 115.2 Kbit/s MIR 0.576 Mbit/s 1.152 Mbit/s FIR 4.0 Mbit/s (Single pulse) 4.0 Mbit/s (Double pulse) 123 248 125 250 128 253 ns ns 414 206 416 208 419 211 ns ns 78.1 19.5 9.75 4.87 3.25 1.62 78.1 19.5 9.75 4.87 3.25 1.62 78.1 19.5 9.75 4.87 3.25 1.62 s s s s s s ELECTRICAL PULSE DURATION MIN TYP MAX UNIT
6.6.8
6.6.8.1
The MMC host controller provides an interface to high-speed and standard MMC, SD memory cards, or SDIO cards. The application interface is responsible for managing transaction semantics. The MMC/SDIO host controller deals with MMC/SDIO protocol at transmission level, packing data, adding CRC, start/end bit, and checking for syntactical correctness. There are three MMC interfaces on the device: MMC1: 1.8-V / 3-V support 4-bit in Standard MMC, High-Speed MMC, Standard SD, and High-Speed SD modes
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
245
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
MMC2: 1.8-V support 8-bit without external transceiver 4-bit with external transceiver allowing supporting 3-V peripherals. Transceiver direction control signals are multiplexed with the upper four data bits. MMC3: 1.8-V support 8-bit without external transceiver
6.6.8.1.1 MMC1 InterfaceSD Identification Modes Table 6-110 and Table 6-111 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 6-109. MMC1 Interface Timing ConditionsSD Identification Modes
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 10 10 40 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
MMC1 Interface (3.0-V IO) SD3 SD4 tsu(CMDV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-CMDIV) 1198.4 1249.2 1198.4 1249.2 ns ns
(1) Corresponding figures showing timing parameters are common with other interface modes. (See SD , HS SD modes). (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
PARAMETER
UNIT
MHz ns ns ns ps
125 200
125 200
246
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-111. MMC1 Interface Switching CharacteristicsSD Identification Modes(4) (7) (continued)
NO. tR(data) tF(data) SD5 td(CLKOH-CMD) PARAMETER Rise time, output data Fall time, output data Delay time, mmc1_clk rising clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition Rise time, output clock Fall time, output clock Rise time, output data Fall time, output data Delay time, mmc1_clk rising clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition 6.3 6.3 OPP100 MIN MAX 10 10 2492.7 6.3 OPP50 MIN MAX 10 10 2492.7 ns ns ns UNIT
MMC1 Interface (3.0-V IO) tR(clk) tF(clk) tR(data) tF(data) SD5 td(CLKOH-CMD) 10 10 10 10 2492.7 6.3 10 10 10 10 2492.7 ns ns ns ns ns
(1) Related with the output clock maximum and minimum frequencies programmable in mmc module. (2) PO = output clock period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) Corresponding figures showing timing parameters are common with other interface modes. (See SD, HS SD modes). (5) The X parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd X 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2]+1)/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (6) The Y parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd Y 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2])/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (7) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
6.6.8.1.2 MMC1 InterfaceHigh-Speed SD Mode Table 6-113 and Table 6-114 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-65 and Figure 6-66). Table 6-112. MMC1 Interface Timing ConditionsHigh-Speed SD Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 3 3 40 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
247
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
MMC1 Interface (3.0-V IO) HSSD3 HSSD4 HSSD7 HSSD8 tsu(CMDV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-CMDIV) tsu(DATxV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-DATxIV) 5.6 2.3 5.6 2.3 26 1.9 26 1.9 ns ns ns ns
248
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
PARAMETER
UNIT
MHz ns ns ps ps
MMC1 Interface (3.0-V IO) tR(clk) tF(clk) tR(data) tF(data) HSSD5 HSSD6 td(CLKOH-CMD) td(CLKOH-DATx) 3 3 3 3 14.11 14.11 4.13 4.13 3 3 3 3 34.53 34.53 ns ns ns ns ns ns
(1) Related with the output clock maximum and minimum frequencies programmable in MMC module. (2) PO = output clock period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) The X parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd X 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2]+1)/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (5) The Y parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd Y 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2])/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (6) In mmc1_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3. (7) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
249
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
HSSD2
HSSD4
HSSD8
SWPS038-094
HSSD2
HSSD5
HSSD6
Figure 6-66. MMC1 InterfaceHigh-Speed SD ModeData/Command Transmit 6.6.8.1.3 MMC1 InterfaceStandard SD Mode Table 6-116 and Table 6-117 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-67 and Figure 6-68). Table 6-115. MMC1 Interface Timing ConditionsStandard SD Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 10 10 40 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
(2) (4)
OPP50 MAX
UNIT
ns ns ns ns
250
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 (2) (4)
(continued)
OPP50 UNIT ns ns ns MAX
(1) Timing parameters are referred to output clock specified in Table 6-117. (2) The timing requirements are assured for the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified in Table 6-117. (3) In mmc1_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
PARAMETER
UNIT
MHz ns ns
2083.33 200
4166.67 200
ps ps
MMC1 Interface (3.0-V) tR(clk) tF(clk) tR(data) tF(data) SD5 SD6 td(CLKOH-CMD) td(CLKOH-DATx) 10 10 10 10 35.53 35.53 6.3 6.3 10 10 10 10 77.03 77.03 ns ns ns ns ns ns
(1) Related with the output clock maximum and minimum frequencies programmable in MMC module. (2) PO = output clock period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) The X parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd X 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2]+1)/CLKD
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
251
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (5) The Y parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd Y 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2])/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (6) In mmc1_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3. (7) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
SD1 mmc1_clk SD3 mmc1_cmd SD7 mmc1_dat[n:0]
SWPS038-098
SD2
SD4
SD8
SD2
SD5
SD6
Figure 6-68. MMC1 InterfaceStandard SD ModeData/Command Transmit 6.6.8.1.4 MMC1 InterfaceStandard MMC and MMC Identification Modes Table 6-119 and Table 6-120 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-69 and Figure 6-70).
252
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-118. MMC1 Interface Timing ConditionsStandard MMC and MMC Identification Modes
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 3 3 30 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Table 6-119. MMC1 Interface Timing RequirementsStandard MMC and MMC Identification Modes(2) (3) (4)
NO. MMC1 Interface (1.8-V IO) MMC3 MMC4 MMC7 MMC8 tsu(CMDV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-CMDIV) tsu(DATxV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-DATxIV) Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge Setup time, mmc1_dat[n:0](1) valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmc1_dat[n:0](1) valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge Setup time, mmc1_dat[n:0](1) valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmc1_dat[n:0](1) valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge 13.6 7.7 13.6 7.7 55.1 7.5 55.1 7.5 ns ns ns ns PARAMETER OPP100 MIN MAX OPP50 MIN MAX UNIT
MMC1 Interface (3.0-V IO) MMC3 MMC4 MMC7 MMC8 tsu(CMDV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-CMDIV) tsu(DATxV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-DATxIV) 13.6 7.7 13.6 7.7 55.1 7.5 55.1 7.5 ns ns ns ns
(1) In mmc1_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3. (2) Timing parameters are referred to output clock specified in Table 6-120. (3) The timing requirements are assured for the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified in Table 6-120. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-120. MMC1 Interface Switching CharacteristicsStandard MMC and MMC Identification Modes(7)
NO. MMC Identification Mode MMC1 MMC2 MMC2 1/tc(clk) tW(clkH) tW(clkL) tdc(clk) tJ(clk) MMC1 MMC2 MMC2 tc(clk) tW(clkH) tW(clkL) tdc(clk) tJ(clk) MMC1 Interface (1.8-V IO) tR(clk) Rise time, output clk 10 10 ns 253 Frequency(1), output clk period Typical pulse duration, output clk high Typical pulse duration, output clk low Duty cycle error, output clk Jitter standard deviation(3), output clk Frequency(1), output clk period Typical pulse duration, output clk high Typical pulse duration, output clk low Duty cycle error, output clk Jitter standard deviation , output clk
(3)
PARAMETER
OPP100 MIN MAX 0.4 X(5)*PO(2) Y(6)*PO(2) 125 200 24 X(5)*PO(2) Y(6)*PO(2) 2083.3 200
OPP50 MIN MAX 0.4 X(5)*PO(2) Y(6)*PO(2) 125 200 12 X(5)*PO(2) Y(6)*PO(2) 4166.7 200
UNIT
MHz ns ns ns ps MHz ns ns ps ps
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 6-120. MMC1 Interface Switching CharacteristicsStandard MMC and MMC Identification Modes(7) (continued)
NO. tF(clk) tR(data) tF(data) MMC5 MMC6 td(CLKOH-CMD) td(CLKOH-DATx) PARAMETER Fall time, output clk Rise time, output data Fall time, output data Delay time, mmc1_clk rising clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition Delay time, mmc1_clk rising clock edge to mmc1_dat[n:0](4) transition Rise time, output clk Fall time, output clk Rise time, output data Fall time, output data Delay time, mmc1_clk rising clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition Delay time, mmc1_clk rising clock edge to mmc1_dat[n:0](4) transition 4.1 4.1 4.1 4.1 OPP100 MIN MAX 10 10 10 37.6 37.6 4.3 4.3 OPP50 MIN MAX 10 10 10 79 79 ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
MMC1 Interface (3.0-V IO) tR(clk) tF(clk) tR(data) tF(data) MMC5 MMC6 td(CLKOH-CMD) td(CLKOH-DATx) 10 10 10 10 37.6 37.6 4.3 4.3 10 10 10 10 79 79 ns ns ns ns ns ns
(1) Related with the output clock maximum and minimum frequencies programmable in MMC module. (2) PO = output clock period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) In mmc1_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3. (5) The X parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd X 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2]+1)/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (6) The Y parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd Y 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2])/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (7) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
MMC1 mmc1_clk MMC3 mmc1_cmd MMC7 mmc1_dat[3:0]
SWPS038-102
MMC2
MMC4
MMC8
Figure 6-69. MMC1 InterfaceStandard MMC and MMC Identification ModesData/Command Receive
254
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
MMC2
MMC5
MMC6
SWPS038-103
Figure 6-70. MMC1 InterfaceStandard MMC and MMC Identification ModesData/Command Transmit 6.6.8.1.5 MMC1 InterfaceHigh-Speed MMC Mode Table 6-122 and Table 6-123 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-71 and Figure 6-72). Table 6-121. MMC1 Interface Timing ConditionsHigh-Speed MMC Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 3 3 30 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Table 6-122. MMC1 Interface Timing RequirementsHigh-Speed MMC Mode(2) (3) (4)
NO. MMC1 Interface (1.8-V IO) MMC3 MMC4 MMC7 MMC8 tsu(CMDV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-CMDIV) tsu(DATxV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-DATxIV) Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge Setup time, mmc1_dat[n:0](1) valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmc1_dat[n:0](1) valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge Setup time, mmc1_dat[n:0](1) valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmc1_dat[n:0](1) valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge 5.6 2.3 5.6 2.3 26.0 1.9 26.0 1.9 PARAMETER OPP100 MIN MAX OPP50 MIN
(5)
UNIT
MAX ns ns ns ns
MMC1 Interface (3.0-V IO) MMC3 MMC4 MMC7 MMC8 tsu(CMDV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-CMDIV) tsu(DATxV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-DATxIV) 5.6 2.3 5.6 2.3 26.0 1.9 26.0 1.9 ns ns ns ns
(1) In mmc1_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3. (2) Timing parameters are referred to output clock specified in Table 6-123. (3) The timing requirements are assured for the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified in Table 6-123. (4) Corresponding figures showing timing parameters are common with the Standard MMC mode figures. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
255
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
UNIT MHz ns ns ps ps
1041.7 200
2083.3 200
MMC1 Interface (3.0-V IO) tR(clk) tF(clk) tR(data) tF(clk) MMC5 MMC6 td(CLKOH-CMD) td(CLKOH-DATx) 3 3 3 3 14.1 14.1 4.1 4.1 3 3 3 3 34.5 34.5 ns ns ns ns ns ns
(1) Related with the output clock maximum and minimum frequencies programmable in MMC module. (2) PO = output clock period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) Corresponding figures showing timing parameters are common with the Standard MMC mode figures. (5) In MMC1_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3. (6) The X parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd X 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2]+1)/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (7) The Y parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd Y 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2])/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (8) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
256
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
MMC2
MMC4
MMC8
SWPS038-100
MMC2
MMC5
MMC6
Figure 6-72. MMC1 InterfaceHigh-Speed MMC ModeData/Command Transmit 6.6.8.1.6 MMC2 and MMC3 InterfacesSDIO Identification Mode Table 6-125 and Table 6-126 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-73 and Figure 6-74). Table 6-124. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Timing ConditionsSDIO Identification Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 10 10 5 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Table 6-125. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Timing RequirementsSDIO Identification Mode(1)(2)
NO. PARAMETER OPP100 MIN MMC2 and MMC3 Interface (1.8-V IO) SD3 SD4 tsu(CMDV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-CMDIV) Setup time, mmcx_cmd valid before mmcx_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmcx_cmd valid after mmcx_clk rising clock edge 1198.4 1249.2 1198.4 1249.2 ns ns MAX MIN OPP50 MAX UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
257
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
Table 6-126. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Switching CharacteristicsSDIO Identification Mode(4)(7)(7)
NO. Standard SDIO Mode SD1 SD2 SD2 tc(clk) tW(clkH) tW(clkL) tdc(clk) tJ(clk) tR(clk) tF(clk) tR(data) tF(data) SD5 td(CLKOH-CMD) Frequency(1), output clock period Typical pulse duration, output clock high Typical pulse duration, output clock low Duty cycle error, output clock Jitter standard deviation(3), output clock Rise time, output clock Fall time, output clock Rise time, output data Fall time, output data Delay time, mmcx_clk rising clock edge to mmcx_cmd transition 6.3 PO X(5) * (2) 0.4 PO X(5) * (2) 0.4 MHz ns ns 125 200 10 10 10 10 6.3 77.03 ns ps ns ns ns ns ns PARAMETER OPP100 MIN MAX MIN OPP50 MAX UNIT
Y(6) * PO(2)
(1) Related to the output mmcx_clk maximum and minimum frequency. (2) P = output mmcx_clk period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) Corresponding figures showing timing parameters are common with other interface modes (see SDIO, HS SDIO modes). (5) The X parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd X 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2]+1)/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (6) The Y parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd Y 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2])/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (7) In mmcx, x is equal to 2 or 3.
6.6.8.1.7 MMC2 and MMC3 InterfacesHigh-Speed SDIO Mode Table 6-128 and Table 6-129 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-73 and Figure 6-74). Table 6-127. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Timing ConditionsHigh-Speed SDIO Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 0.18 0.19 5 5.69 5.70 ns ns pF VALUE MAX UNIT
Output Condition
258
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-128. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Timing RequirementsHigh-Speed SDIO Mode(2)
NO. HSSD3 HSSD4 HSSD7 HSSD8 tsu(dV-clkH) th(clkH-dV) tsu(dV-clkH) th(clkH-dV) PARAMETER Setup time, mmcx_cmd valid before mmcx_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmcx_cmd valid after mmcx_clk rising clock edge Setup time, mmcx_dat[n:0](1) valid before mmcx_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmcx_dat[n:0](1) valid after mmcx_clk rising clock edge OPP100 MIN 3.4 1.7 3.4 1.7 MAX OPP50 MIN 23.8 1.3 23.8 1.3 MAX ns ns ns ns UNIT
(1) In mmcx_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3 for mmc2 and 7 for mmc3. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Table 6-129. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Switching CharacteristicsHigh-Speed SDIO Mode(2)
NO. HSSD1 HSSD2 HSSD2 tc(clk) tW(clkH) tW(clkL) tdc(clk) tJ(clk) HSSD5 HSSD6 td(clkL-doV) td(clkL-doV) PARAMETER Frequency(1), output mmcx_clk period Typical pulse duration, output mmcx_clk high Typical pulse duration, output mmcx_clk low Duty cycle error, output mmcx_clk Jitter standard deviation(4), output mmcx_clk Delay time, mmcx_clk rising clock edge to mmcx_cmd transition Delay time, mmcx_clk rising clock edge to mmcx_dat[n:0](2) transition 65 2.6 2.6 0.5*P(3) 0.5*P(3) 1042 1042 65 13.8 13.8 65 3 3 OPP100 MIN MAX 48 0.5*P(3) 0.5*P(3) 2083 2083 65 34.3 34.3 OPP50 MIN MAX 24
(5)
UNIT MHz ns ns ps ps ns ns
(1) Related with the output mmcx_clk maximum and minimum frequency. (2) In mmcx, x = 2 or 3. In mmcx_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3 for mmc2 and 7 for mmc3. (3) P = output mmcx_clk period in ns. (4) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
HSSD1 HSSD2 mmcx_clk HSSD3 mmcx_cmd HSSD7 mmcx_dat[n:0]
SWPS038-096
HSSD2
HSSD4
HSSD8
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
259
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
HSSD2
HSSD5
HSSD6
6.6.8.1.8 MMC2 and MMC3 InterfacesStandard SDIO Mode Table 6-131 and Table 6-132 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 5-89 and Figure 5-90). Table 6-130. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Timing ConditionsStandard SDIO Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 10 10 5 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Table 6-131. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Timing RequirementsStandard SDIO Mode(2)(3)
NO. MMC2 and MMC3 Interface (1.8-V IO) SD3 SD4 SD7 SD8 tsu(CMDV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-CMDIV) tsu(DATxV-CLKIH) th(CLKIH-DATxIV) Setup time, mmcx_cmd valid before mmcx_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmcx_cmd valid after mmcx_clk rising clock edge Setup time, mmcx_dat[n:0](1) valid before mmcx_clk rising clock edge Hold time, mmcx_dat[n:0](1) valid after mmcx_clk rising clock edge 3.3 18.1 3.3 18.1 21.9 36.7 21.9 36.7 ns ns ns ns PARAMETER OPP100 MIN MAX MIN OPP50 MAX UNIT
(1) In mmcx_dat[n:0], n is equal to 3 for MMC2 and 7 for MMC3. (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks. (3) In mmcx, x is equal to 2 or 3.
Table 6-132. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Switching CharacteristicsStandard SDIO Mode(6)(7)
NO. Standard SDIO Mode SD1 SD2 SD2 tc(clk) tW(clkH) tW(clkL) tdc(clk) 260 Frequency(1), output clock period Typical pulse duration, output clock high Typical pulse duration, output clock low Duty cycle error, output clock X(4) * PO(2) Y(5) * PO(2) 2083.33 24 X(4) * PO(2) Y(5) * PO(2) 4166.67 12 MHz ns ns ps PARAMETER OPP100 MIN MAX MIN OPP50 MAX UNIT
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-132. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Switching CharacteristicsStandard SDIO Mode(6)(7) (continued)
NO. tJ(clk) tR(clk) tF(clk) tR(data) tF(data) SD5 SD6 td(CLKOH-CMD) td(CLKOH-DATx) PARAMETER Jitter standard deviation(3), output clock Rise time, output clock Fall time, output clock Rise time, output data Fall time, output data Delay time, mmcx_clk rising clock edge to mmcx_cmd transition Delay time, mmcx_clk rising clock edge to mmcx_dat[n:0](6) transition 6.13 6.13 OPP100 MIN MAX 200 10 10 10 10 35.53 35.53 6.3 6.3 MIN OPP50 MAX 200 10 10 10 10 77.03 77.03 ps ns ns ns ns ns ns UNIT
(1) Related to the output mmcx_clk maximum and minimum frequency. (2) P = output mmcx_clk period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) The X parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd X 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2]+1)/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (5) The Y parameter is defined as follows: CLKD 1 or Even Odd Y 0.5 (trunk[CLKD/2])/CLKD
All required details about clock division factor CLKD can be found in the AM/DM37x Multimedia Device Technical Reference Manual (literature number SPRUGN4). (6) In mmcx, x is equal to 2 or 3. In mmcx_dat[n :0] is equal to 3 for mmc2 and 7 for mmc3. (7) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
SD1 mmc1_clk SD3 mmc1_cmd SD7 mmc1_dat[n:0]
SWPS038-098
SD2
SD4
SD8
(1)
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
261
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
SD2
SD5
SD6
SWPS038-099
(1)
6.6.8.1.9 MMC2 and MMC3 InterfacesEmbedded Media Interface (eMMC)High-Speed JC64 Mode Table 6-134 and Table 6-135 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-77 through Figure 6-78). Table 6-133. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Timing ConditionsHigh-Speed JC64 Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance(1) 0.38 0.39 14 3.82 3.68 ns ns pF VALUE MAX UNIT
Table 6-134. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Timing RequirementsHigh-Speed JC64 Mode(1)
NO. MMC3 MMC4 MMC7 MMC8 tsu(cmdV-clkH) th(clkH-cmdIV) tsu(dV-clkH) th(clkH-dIV) PARAMETER Setup time, input command mmcx_cmd valid before output clock mmcx_clk rising edge Hold time, input command mmcx_cmd valid after output clock mmcx_clk rising edge Setup time, input data mmcx_dat[n:0] valid before output clock mmcx_clk rising edge Hold time, input data mmcx_dat[n:0] valid after output clock mmcx_clk rising edge OPP100 MIN 5.1 1.3 5.1 1.3 MAX OPP50 MIN 25.5 0.9 25.5 0.9 MAX ns ns ns ns UNIT
(1) In mmx_dat[n:0], x is equal to 2 or 3 and n is equal to 7. (2) In mmx_cmd, x is equal to 2 or 3. (3) In mmx_clk, x is equal to 2 or 3.
Table 6-135. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Switching CharacteristicsHigh-Speed JC64 Mode(5) (6)(7)
NO. MMC1 MMC2 MMC2 1/tc(clk) tW(clkH) tW(clkL) tdc(clk) tJ(clk) tR(clk) tF(clk) 262 PARAMETER Frequency(1), output mmcx_clk period Typical pulse duration, output mmcx_clk high Typical pulse duration, output mmcx_clk low Duty cycle error, output mmcx_clk Jitter standard deviation(3), output mmcx_clk Rising time, output mmcx_clk Falling time, output mmcx_clk 65 0.5*P 1042
(2)
UNIT MHz ns ns ps ps ps ps 65
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Table 6-135. MMC2 and MMC3 Interfaces Switching CharacteristicsHigh-Speed JC64 Mode(5) (6)(7) (continued)
NO. MMC5 td(clkL-doV) tR(do) tF(do) MMC6 td(clkL-doV) tR(do) tF(do) PARAMETER Delay time, mmcx_clk rising clock edge to mmcx_cmd transition Rising time, output mmcx_cmd Falling time, output mmcx_cmd Delay time, mmcx_clk rising clock edge to mmcx_daty transition Rising time, output mmcx_dat[n:0](4) Falling time, output mmcx_dat[n:0]
(4)
OPP100 MIN 3.6 MAX 16.8 2263 2136 3.6 16.8 2263 2136 4 4
UNIT ns ps ps ns ps ps
(1) Related with the output clock maximum and minimum frequencies programmable in MMC module. (2) PO = output clock period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) In mmx_dat[n:0], x is equal to 2 or 3 and n is equal to 7. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks. (6) In mmx_cmd, x is equal to 2 or 3. (7) In mmx_clk, x is equal to 2 or 3.
MMC1 MMC2 mmcx_clk MMC5 mmcx_cmd MMC6 mmcx_dat[n:0]
SWPS038-104
MMC2
MMC5
MMC6
MMC2
MMC4
MMC8
(1)(2)(3)
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
263
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.6.9
6.6.9.1
Test Interfaces
Embedded Trace Macro Interface (ETM)
Table 6-137 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-79). Table 6-136. ETM Timing ConditionsTransmit Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER MIN Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 10 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 1. VALUE MAX UNIT
PARAMETER Frequency(3), output clock etk_clk Pulse duration, output clock etk_clk high Pulse duration, output clock etk_clk low Duty cycle error, output clock etk_clk Jitter standard deviation(2), output clock etk_clk Rise time, output clock etk_clk Fall time, output clock etk_clk Delay time, output clock etk_clk low/high to output control etk_ctl transition Delay time, output clock etk_clk low/high to output data etk_d[15:0] transition Rise time, output data etk_d[15:0] and output control etk_ctl Fall time, output data etk_d[15:0] and output control etk_ctl
301
TPIU3
TPIU4
TPIU5
264
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
6.6.9.2
The System Debug Trace Interface (SDTI) module provides real-time software tracing functionality to the device. The trace interface has four trace data pins and a trace clock pin. This interface is a dual-edge interface: The data are available on rising and falling edge of sdti_clk. But can be also configured in single-edge mode where data are available on the falling edge of sdti_clk. Serial interface operates in clock stop regime: serial clock is not free-running; when there is no trace data, there is no trace clock. 6.6.9.2.1 SDTIDual-Edge Mode Table 6-139 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-80). Table 6-138. SDTI Timing ConditionsDual-Edge Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 25 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 1. VALUE UNIT
UNIT MHz ns ns
(1) P = sdti_clk clock period in ns (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
SD1 sdti_clk SD3 sdti_txd[3:0] Header Header SD3 Ad[7:4] Ad[3:0] Da[15:12] Da[11:8] Da[7:4] Da[3:0]
SWPS038-107
SD2
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
265
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
6.6.9.2.2 SDTISingle-Edge Mode Table 6-141 assumes testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-81). Table 6-140. SDTI Timing ConditionsSingle-Edge Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Output Condition CLOAD Output load capacitance(1) 25 pF (1) Buffer strength configuration: LB0 = 1. VALUE UNIT
(1) P = sdti_clk clock period in ns (2) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
SD1 sdti_clk SD3 sdti_txd[3:0] Header Header SD3 Ad[7:4] Ad[3:0] Da[15:12] Da[11:8] Da[7:4] Da[3:0]
SWPS038-108
SD2
The JTAG TAP controller handles standard IEEE JTAG interfaces. The following section defines the timing requirements for several tools used to test the device as: Free-running clock tool, like XDS560 and XDS510 tools Adaptive clock tool, like RealView ICE tool and LauterbachTM tool 6.6.9.3.1 JTAGFree-Running Clock Mode Table 6-143 and Table 6-144 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-82). Table 6-142. JTAG Timing ConditionsFree-Running Clock Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance 5 5 30 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Output Condition
266
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
OPP50 MIN MAX 50 0.5P(2) 0.5P 1667 1667 1.6 1.0 1.6 1.0 19.6 2.7
(2)
UNIT MHz ns ns ps ps ns ns ns ns ns ns
1250 1250
1667 1667
(1) Related with the input maximum frequency supported by the JTAG module. (2) P = input clock jtag _tck period in ns (3) Maximum cycle jitter supported by input clock jtag _tck. (4) In jtag_emux, x is equal to 0 or 1. (5) The timing requirements are assured for the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified. (6) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
(1) Related with the jtag_rtck maximum frequency. (2) P = output clock jtag _rtck period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) In jtag_emux, x is equal to 0 or 1. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
267
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
JT4 JT5 jtag_tck JT1 JT2 jtag_rtck JT7 jtag_tdi JT9 jtag_tms_tmsc JT12 jtag_emux(IN) JT11 jtag_tdo JT14 jtag_emux(OUT)
SWPS038-109
JT6
(1)
In jtag_emux, x is equal to 0 or 1.
Figure 6-82. JTAGFree-Running Clock Mode 6.6.9.3.2 JTAGAdaptative Clock Mode Table 6-146 and Table 6-147 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 6-83). Table 6-145. JTAG Timing ConditionsAdaptative Clock Mode
TIMING CONDITION PARAMETER Input Conditions tR tF CLOAD Input signal rise time Input signal fall time Output load capacitance 5 5 30 ns ns pF VALUE UNIT
Output Condition
OPP50 MIN MAX 50 0.5P(2) 0.5P 2500 1500 13.8 13.8 13.8 13.8
(2)
UNIT MHz ns ns ps ps ns ns ns ns
2500 1500
2500 1500
268
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
(1) Related with the input maximum frequency supported by the JTAG module (2) P = input clock jtag _tck period in ns (3) Maximum cycle jitter supported by input clock jtag _tck. (4) The timing requirements are assured for the cycle jitter and duty cycle error conditions specified. (5) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
(1) Related to the jtag _rtck maximum frequency programmable. (2) P = output clock jtag _rtck period in ns (3) The jitter probability density can be approximated by a Gaussian function. (4) See Section 4.3.4, Processor Clocks.
JA4 JA5 jtag_tck JA7 jtag_tdi JA9 jtag_tms JA1 JA2 jtag_rtck JA11 jtag_tdo
SWPS038-110
JA3
Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
269
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
7 Package Characteristics
7.1 Package Thermal Characteristics
Table 7-1 and Table 7-2 provide the thermal resistance characteristics for the packages used on this device. Note: This table provides simulation data and may not represent actual use-case values. Table 7-1. Thermal Resistance Characteristics 800MHz ARM Operation-4Gb DDR + Flash
PACKAGE CBP Package CBC Package CUS Package Power (W)(5) 1.42 1.42 1.05 JA(C/W)(2) 20.06 19.97 24.75 JB(C/W)(3) 6.44 7.76 11.06 JC(C/W)(4)
(6) (6)
7.06
(1) The board types are defined by JEDEC (reference JEDEC standard JESD51-9, Test Board for Array Surface Mount Package Thermal Measurements). (2) JA (Theta-JA) = Thermal Resistance Junction-to-Ambient, C/W (3) JB (Theta-JB) = Thermal Resistance Junction-to-Board, C/W (4) JC (Theta-JC) = Thermal Resistance Junction-to-Board, C/W (5) These power numbers are based on simulation results for DM37x. Power numbers for CBP and CBC packages include the DM37x device and POP memory. CUS package is DM37x only. (6) Not applicable since these packages have memory package mounted on top.
7.06
(1) The board types are defined by JEDEC (reference JEDEC standard JESD51-9, Test Board for Array Surface Mount Package Thermal Measurements). (2) JA (Theta-JA) = Thermal Resistance Junction-to-Ambient, C/W (3) JB (Theta-JB) = Thermal Resistance Junction-to-Board, C/W (4) JC (Theta-JC) = Thermal Resistance Junction-to-Board, C/W (5) These power numbers are based on simulation results for DM37x. Power numbers for CBP and CBC packages include the DM37x device and POP memory. CUS package is DM37x only. (6) Not applicable since these packages have memory package mounted on top.
7.2 7.2.1
270
Package Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
Support tool development evolutionary flow: TMDX TMDS Development support product that has not yet completed Texas Instruments internal qualification testing. Fully qualified development support product.
TMX and TMP devices and TMDX development-support tools are shipped against the following disclaimer: Developmental product is intended for internal evaluation purposes. Production devices and TMDS development-support tools have been characterized fully, and the quality and reliability of the device have been demonstrated fully. TIs standard warranty applies. Predictions show that prototype devices (X or P), have a greater failure rate than the standard production devices. Texas Instruments recommends that these devices not be used in any production system because their expected end-use failure rate still is undefined. Only qualified production devices are to be used. For additional description of the device nomenclature markings, see the Processor Silicon Errata.
X PREFIX X = Experimental Device P = Prototype Device blank = Production Device DEVICE SILICON REVISION DM3730 ( ) CBP ( )
( )
( )
blank = tray R = tape and reel blank = commercial temperature A = extended temperature D = industrial temperature PACKAGE TYPE CBP = 515-pin sPBGA CBC = 515-pin sPBGA CUS = 423-pin sPBGA
7.2.2
7.2.2.1
Documentation Support
Related Documentation from Texas Instruments
The following documents describe the DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor. Copies of these documents are available on the Internet at www.ti.com. Tip: Enter the literature number in the search box provided at www.ti.com. The current documentation that describes the DM3730/25 Digital Media Processor, related peripherals, and other technical collateral, is available in the product folder at: www.ti.com. SPRUGN4 . Collection of documents providing detailed information on the SitaraTM architecture including power, reset, and clock control, interrupts, memory map, and switch fabric interconnect. Detailed information on the microprocessor unit (MPU) subsystem as well a functional description of the peripherals supported on DM3730/25devices is also included.
7.2.2.1.1 Community Resources The following links connect to TI community resources. Linked contents are provided "AS IS" by the respective contributors. They do not constitute TI specifications and do not necessarily reflect TI's views; see TI's Terms of Use. TI E2E Community TI's Engineer-to-Engineer (E2E) Community. Created to foster collaboration among engineers. At e2e.ti.com, you can ask questions, share knowledge, explore ideas and help solve problems with fellow engineers.
Copyright 20102011, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Package Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
271
DM3730, DM3725
SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011 www.ti.com
TI Embedded Processors Wiki Texas Instruments Embedded Processors Wiki. Established to help developers get started with Embedded Processors from Texas Instruments and to foster innovation and growth of general knowledge about the hardware and software surrounding these devices. 7.2.2.2 Related Documentation from Other Sources
The following documents are related to the DM3730, DM3725 Digital Media Processors. Copies of these documents can be obtained directly from the internet or from your Texas Instruments representative. Cortex-A8 Technical Reference Manual. This is the technical reference manual for the Cortex-A8 processor. A copy of this document can be obtained via the internet at http://infocenter.arm.com. Please see the DM3730, DM3725 Digital Media Processors Silicon Errata (literature number SPRZ319) to determine the revision of the Cortex-A8 core used on your device. ARM Core CortexTM-A8 (AT400/AT401) Errata Notice. Provides a list of advisories for the different revisions of the Cortex-A8 processor. Contact your TI representative for a copy of this document. Please see the DM3730, DM3725 Digital Media Processors Silicon Errata (literature number SPRZ319) to determine the revision of the Cortex-A8 core used on your device.
272
Package Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
DM3730, DM3725
www.ti.com SPRS685D AUGUST 2010 REVISED JULY 2011
7.3
Mechanical Data
Package Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Link(s): DM3730 DM3725
273
www.ti.com
17-Feb-2013
PACKAGING INFORMATION
Orderable Device DM3725CBC DM3725CBC100 DM3725CBCA DM3725CBCD100 DM3725CBP DM3725CBP100 DM3725CBPA DM3725CBPD100 DM3725CUS DM3725CUS100 DM3725CUSA DM3725CUSD100 DM3730CBC DM3730CBC100 DM3730CBCA DM3730CBCD100 DM3730CBP Status
(1)
Package Type Package Pins Package Qty Drawing POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA FCBGA FCBGA FCBGA FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA CBC CBC CBC CBC CBP CBP CBP CBP CUS CUS CUS CUS CBC CBC CBC CBC CBP 515 515 515 515 515 515 515 515 423 423 423 423 515 515 515 515 515 1 119 119 119 168 168 168 168 90 90 90 90 119 119 119 119 168
Eco Plan
(2)
Lead/Ball Finish Call TI Call TI SNAGCU Call TI Call TI Call TI SNAGCU Call TI Call TI Call TI SNAGCU Call TI Call TI Call TI SNAGCU Call TI Call TI
Op Temp (C) 0 to 90 0 to 90 -40 to 105 -40 to 90 0 to 90 0 to 90 -40 to 105 -40 to 90 0 to 90 0 to 90 -40 to 105 -40 to 90 0 to 90 0 to 90 -40 to 105 -40 to 90 0 to 90
Top-Side Markings
(4)
Samples
ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE ACTIVE
Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br)
Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR Level-3-260C-168 HR
DM3725CBC DM3725CBC100 DM3725CBCA DM3725CBCD100 DM3725CBP DM3725CBP-AS3 DM3725CBP100 DM3725CBP100-AS3 DM3725CBPA DM3725CBPD100 DM3725CBPD100-AS3 DM3725CUS DM3725CUS100 DM3725CUSA DM3725CUSD100 DM3730CBC DM3730CBC100 DM3730CBCA DM3730CBCD100 DM3730CBP DM3730CBP-AS3
Addendum-Page 1
www.ti.com
17-Feb-2013
Orderable Device DM3730CBP100 DM3730CBPA DM3730CBPD100 DM3730CUS DM3730CUS100 DM3730CUSA DM3730CUSD100 XDM3730CBP
(1)
Status
(1)
Package Type Package Pins Package Qty Drawing POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA POP-FCBGA FCBGA FCBGA FCBGA FCBGA CBP CBP CBP CUS CUS CUS CUS CBP 515 515 515 423 423 423 423 515 168 1 168 90 90 90 90
Eco Plan
(2)
Lead/Ball Finish Call TI SNAGCU Call TI Call TI Call TI SNAGCU Call TI Call TI
Top-Side Markings
(4)
Samples
Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) TBD
OBSOLETE POP-FCBGA
The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device.
(2)
Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material)
(3)
MSL, Peak Temp. -- The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. Only one of markings shown within the brackets will appear on the physical device.
(4)
Addendum-Page 2
www.ti.com
17-Feb-2013
Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis.
Addendum-Page 3
IMPORTANT NOTICE
Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as components) are sold subject to TIs terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TIs terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TIs goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or enhanced plastic are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Audio Amplifiers Data Converters DLP Products DSP Clocks and Timers Interface Logic Power Mgmt Microcontrollers RFID OMAP Applications Processors Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/audio amplifier.ti.com dataconverter.ti.com www.dlp.com dsp.ti.com www.ti.com/clocks interface.ti.com logic.ti.com power.ti.com microcontroller.ti.com www.ti-rfid.com www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Applications Automotive and Transportation Communications and Telecom Computers and Peripherals Consumer Electronics Energy and Lighting Industrial Medical Security Space, Avionics and Defense Video and Imaging www.ti.com/automotive www.ti.com/communications www.ti.com/computers www.ti.com/consumer-apps www.ti.com/energy www.ti.com/industrial www.ti.com/medical www.ti.com/security www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense www.ti.com/video